xref: /openbmc/linux/include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h (revision 2243acd5)
1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2022 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59 
60 /**
61  * DOC: Station handling
62  *
63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67  * to.
68  *
69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70  * capabilities.
71  *
72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75  *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78  *    time mark it authorized.
79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82  *
83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84  */
85 
86 /**
87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88  *
89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93  * for various reasons.
94  *
95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101  * for doing that.
102  *
103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106  *
107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113  *
114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118  *
119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120  * below.
121  */
122 
123 /**
124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125  *
126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130  *
131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
134  *
135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138  * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142  *
143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151  *
152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
154  */
155 
156 /**
157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
158  *
159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162  * and power consumption.
163  *
164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167  * following events occur.
168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit.
171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172  *
173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174  * rule.
175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177  * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
179  */
180 
181 /**
182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183  *
184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186  * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191  *
192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195  * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196  * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197  * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198  * not present.
199  *
200  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202  * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203  * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204  * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205  * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206  * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207  *
208  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211  */
212 
213 /**
214  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215  *
216  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
217  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231  *
232  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234  * up a connection or after roaming.
235  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241  *
242  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
243  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249  */
250 
251 /**
252  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253  *
254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256  * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257  * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258  *
259  * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261  * respectively.
262  */
263 
264 /**
265  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266  *
267  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273  * that main netdev.
274  *
275  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278  */
279 
280 /**
281  * DOC: TID configuration
282  *
283  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285  *
286  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289  *
290  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293  * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values
295  * will be overwritten.
296  *
297  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection
298  * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300  * the interface goes down.
301  */
302 
303 /**
304  * DOC: FILS shared key crypto offload
305  *
306  * This feature is applicable to drivers running in AP mode.
307  *
308  * FILS shared key crypto offload can be advertised by drivers by setting
309  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
310  * FILS shared key crypto offload should be able to encrypt and decrypt
311  * association frames for FILS shared key authentication as per IEEE 802.11ai.
312  * With this capability, for FILS key derivation, drivers depend on userspace.
313  *
314  * After FILS key derivation, userspace shares the FILS AAD details with the
315  * driver and the driver stores the same to use in decryption of association
316  * request and in encryption of association response. The below parameters
317  * should be given to the driver in %NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
318  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC - STA MAC address, used for storing FILS AAD per STA
319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - Used for encryption or decryption
320  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - Used for encryption or decryption
321  *			(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
322  *
323  * Once the association is done, the driver cleans the FILS AAD data.
324  */
325 
326 /**
327  * DOC: Multi-Link Operation
328  *
329  * In Multi-Link Operation, a connection between to MLDs utilizes multiple
330  * links. To use this in nl80211, various commands and responses now need
331  * to or will include the new %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS attribute.
332  * Additionally, various commands that need to operate on a specific link
333  * now need to be given the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute, e.g. to
334  * use %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or similar functions.
335  */
336 
337 /**
338  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
339  *
340  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
341  *
342  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
343  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
344  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
345  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
346  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
347  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
348  *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
349  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
350  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
351  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
352  *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
353  *	compatibility only.
354  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
355  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
356  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
357  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
358  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
359  *
360  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
361  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
362  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
363  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
364  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
365  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
366  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
367  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
368  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
369  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
370  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
371  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
372  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
373  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
374  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. If multiple BSSID advertisements are
375  *	enabled using %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG, %NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
376  *	and if this command is used for the transmitting interface, then all
377  *	the non-transmitting interfaces are deleted as well.
378  *
379  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
380  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
381  *	represents peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. For MLO group key,
382  *	the link is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
383  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
384  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
385  *	For MLO connection, the link to set default key is identified by
386  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
387  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
388  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
389  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents
390  *	peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. The link to add MLO
391  *	group key is identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
392  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
393  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC represents peer's MLD address
394  *	for MLO pairwise key. The link to delete group key is identified by
395  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID.
396  *
397  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
398  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
399  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
400  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
401  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
402  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
403  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
404  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
405  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
406  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
407  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
408  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
409  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
410  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
412  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
413  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
414  *	attributes determining channel width.
415  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
416  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
417  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
418  *
419  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
420  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
421  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
422  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
423  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
424  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
425  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
426  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
427  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. For MLD station, MLD address is used in
428  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
429  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
430  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
431  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
432  *	frame).
433  *
434  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
435  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
436  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
437  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
438  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
439  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
440  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
441  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
442  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
443  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
444  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
445  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
446  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
447  *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
448  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
449  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
450  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
451  *
452  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
453  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
454  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
455  *	global regdomain will be returned.
456  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
457  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
458  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
459  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
460  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
461  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
462  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
463  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
464  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
465  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
466  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
467  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
468  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
469  * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
470  * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
471  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
472  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
473  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
474  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
475  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
476  * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
477  * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
478  *
479  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
480  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
481  *
482  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
483  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
484  *
485  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
486  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
487  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
488  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
489  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
490  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
491  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
492  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
493  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
494  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
495  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
496  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
497  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
498  *
499  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
500  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
501  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
502  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
503  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
504  *	be used.
505  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
506  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
507  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
508  *	partial scan results may be available
509  *
510  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
511  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
512  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
513  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
514  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
515  *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
516  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
517  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
518  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
519  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
520  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
521  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
522  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
523  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
524  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
525  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
526  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
527  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
528  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
529  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
530  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
531  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
532  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
533  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
534  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
535  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
536  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
537  *	results available.
538  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
539  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
540  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
541  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
542  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
543  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
544  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
545  *
546  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
547  *      or noise level
548  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
549  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
550  *
551  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
552  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
553  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
554  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
555  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
556  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
557  *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
558  *	ESS.
559  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
560  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
561  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
562  *	authentication.
563  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
564  *
565  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
566  * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
567  * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
568  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
569  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
570  * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
571  * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
572  * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
573  * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
574  * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
575  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
576  * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
577  * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
578  * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
579  * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
580  * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
581  * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
582  * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
583  * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
584  * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
585  * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
586  * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
587  * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
588  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
589  * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
590  * 	the beacon hint was processed.
591  *
592  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
593  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
594  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
595  *	authentication process.
596  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
597  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
598  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
599  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
600  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
601  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the
602  *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
603  *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
604  *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
605  *	to the frame.
606  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
607  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
608  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
609  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
610  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
611  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
612  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
613  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
614  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
615  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
616  *	pending authentication timed out).
617  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
618  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
619  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
620  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
621  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
622  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
623  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
624  *	included).
625  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
626  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
627  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
628  *	primitives).
629  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
630  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
631  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
632  *
633  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
634  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
635  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
636  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
637  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
638  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
639  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
640  *
641  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
642  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
643  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
644  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
645  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
646  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
647  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
648  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
649  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
650  *	determined by the network interface.
651  *
652  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
653  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
654  *	to the driver.
655  *
656  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
657  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
658  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
659  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
660  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
661  *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
662  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
663  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
664  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
665  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
666  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
667  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
668  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
669  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
670  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
671  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
672  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
673  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
674  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
675  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
676  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
677  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
678  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
679  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
680  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
681  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
682  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
683  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
684  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
685  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
686  *	a different BSS is desired.
687  *	Background scan period can optionally be
688  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
689  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
690  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
691  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
692  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
693  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
694  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
695  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
696  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
697  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
698  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
699  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
700  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
701  *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
702  *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
703  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
704  *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
705  *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
706  *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
707  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
708  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
709  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
710  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
711  *
712  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
713  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
714  *
715  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
716  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
717  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
718  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
719  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
720  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
721  *	frequency for the operation.
722  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
723  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
724  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
725  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
726  *	radio).
727  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
728  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
729  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
730  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
731  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
732  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
733  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
734  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
735  *	uniquely identify the request.
736  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
737  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
738  *
739  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
740  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
741  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
742  *
743  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
744  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
745  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
746  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
747  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
748  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
749  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
750  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
751  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
752  *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
753  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
754  *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
755  *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
756  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
757  *	backward compatibility
758  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
759  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
760  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
761  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
762  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
763  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
764  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
765  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
766  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
767  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
768  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
769  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
770  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
771  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
772  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
773  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
774  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
775  *	is used during CSA period.
776  *	For TX on an MLD, the frequency can be omitted and the link ID be
777  *	specified, or if transmitting to a known peer MLD (with MLD addresses
778  *	in the frame) both can be omitted and the link will be selected by
779  *	lower layers.
780  *	For RX notification, %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
781  *	indicate the frame RX timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may
782  *	be included to indicate the ack TX timestamp.
783  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
784  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
785  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
786  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
787  *	wait time.
788  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
789  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
790  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
791  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
792  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
793  *	the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to indicate the
794  *	tx timestamp and %NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP may be included to
795  *	indicate the ack RX timestamp.
796  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
797  *	backward compatibility.
798  *
799  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
800  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
801  *
802  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
803  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
804  *	levels.
805  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
806  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
807  *	reached.
808  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
809  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
810  *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
811  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
812  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
813  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
814  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
815  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
816  *	precedence when they are used.
817  *
818  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
819  *	(no longer supported).
820  *
821  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
822  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
823  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
824  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
825  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
826  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
827  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
828  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
829  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
830  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
831  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
832  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
833  *	command, the feature is disabled.
834  *
835  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
836  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
837  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
838  *	network is determined by the network interface.
839  *
840  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
841  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
842  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
843  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
844  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
845  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
846  *
847  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
848  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
849  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
850  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
851  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
852  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
853  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
854  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
855  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
856  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
857  *      depending on the authentication result.
858  *
859  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
860  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
861  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
862  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
863  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
864  *	more background information, see
865  *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
866  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
867  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
868  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
869  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
870  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
871  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
872  *
873  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
874  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
875  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
876  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
877  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
878  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
879  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
880  *
881  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
882  *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
883  *
884  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
885  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
886  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
887  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
888  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
889  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
890  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
891  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
892  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
893  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
894  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
895  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
896  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
897  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
898  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
899  *
900  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
901  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
902  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
903  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
904  *	is received.
905  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
906  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
907  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
908  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
909  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
910  *
911  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
912  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
913  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
914  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
915  *
916  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
917  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
918  *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
919  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
920  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
921  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
922  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
923  *
924  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
925  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
926  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
927  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
928  *
929  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
930  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
931  *
932  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
933  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
934  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
935  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
936  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
937  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
938  *
939  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
940  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
941  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
942  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
943  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
944  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
945  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
946  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
947  *
948  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
949  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
950  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
951  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
952  *	public action frame TX.
953  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
954  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
955  *
956  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
957  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
958  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
959  *	is used for this.
960  *
961  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
962  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
963  *
964  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
965  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
966  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
967  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
968  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
969  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
970  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
971  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
972  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
973  *
974  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
975  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
976  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
977  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
978  *	while operating on this channel.
979  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
980  *	event.
981  *
982  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
983  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
984  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
985  *
986  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
987  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
988  *
989  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
990  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
991  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
992  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
993  *
994  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
995  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
996  *	complete.
997  *
998  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
999  *	return back to normal.
1000  *
1001  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
1002  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
1003  *
1004  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
1005  *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
1006  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
1007  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
1008  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
1009  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
1010  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
1011  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
1012  *	switch is complete.
1013  *
1014  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
1015  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
1016  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
1017  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
1018  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
1019  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
1020  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
1021  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
1022  *
1023  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
1024  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
1025  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
1026  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
1027  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
1028  *
1029  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
1030  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
1031  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
1032  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
1033  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
1034  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
1035  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
1036  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
1037  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
1038  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
1039  *	fail even if the check was successful.
1040  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
1041  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
1042  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
1043  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
1044  *
1045  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
1046  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
1047  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
1048  *
1049  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
1050  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
1051  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
1052  *	network is determined by the network interface.
1053  *
1054  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1055  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1056  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1057  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1058  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1059  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1060  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1061  *	AP.
1062  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1063  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1064  *	when this command completes.
1065  *
1066  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1067  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1068  *	management.
1069  *
1070  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1071  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1072  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1073  *
1074  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1075  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1076  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1077  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1078  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1079  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1080  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1081  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1082  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1083  *	added.
1084  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1085  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1086  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1087  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1088  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1089  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1090  *	of the function upon success.
1091  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1092  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1093  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1094  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1095  *	which just terminated.
1096  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1097  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1098  *	the response to this command.
1099  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1100  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1101  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1102  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1103  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1104  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1105  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1106  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1107  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1108  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1109  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1110  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1111  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1112  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1113  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1114  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1115  *
1116  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1117  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1118  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1119  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1120  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1121  *
1122  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1123  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1124  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1125  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1126  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1127  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1128  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1129  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was
1130  *	completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload
1131  *	should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with
1132  *	%NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT
1133  *	should be indicated instead.
1134  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1135  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1136  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1137  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1138  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1139  *	802.11 headers.
1140  *	For an MLD transmitter, the %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID may be given and
1141  *	its effect will depend on the destination: If the destination is known
1142  *	to be an MLD, this will be used as a hint to select the link to transmit
1143  *	the frame on. If the destination is not an MLD, this will select both
1144  *	the link to transmit on and the source address will be set to the link
1145  *	address of that link.
1146  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1147  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1148  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1149  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1150  *
1151  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1152  *
1153  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1154  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1155  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1156  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1157  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1158  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1159  *
1160  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1161  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1162  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1163  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1164  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1165  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1166  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1167  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1168  *	command interface.
1169  *
1170  *	Host driver sends MLD address of the AP with %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR in
1171  *	%NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH event to indicate user space to enable MLO
1172  *	during the authentication offload in STA mode while connecting to MLD
1173  *	APs. Host driver should check %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT flag capability
1174  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space supports enabling
1175  *	MLO during the authentication offload or not.
1176  *	User space should enable MLO during the authentication only when it
1177  *	receives the AP MLD address in authentication offload request. User
1178  *	space shouldn't enable MLO when the authentication offload request
1179  *	doesn't indicate the AP MLD address even if the AP is MLO capable.
1180  *	User space should use %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR as peer's MLD address and
1181  *	interface address identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX as self MLD
1182  *	address. User space and host driver to use MLD addresses in RA, TA and
1183  *	BSSID fields of the frames between them, and host driver translates the
1184  *	MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link chosen for the
1185  *	authentication.
1186  *
1187  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1188  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1189  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1190  *
1191  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1192  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1193  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1194  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1195  *
1196  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1197  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1198  *
1199  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1200  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1201  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1202  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1203  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1204  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1205  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1206  *	the netlink extended ack message.
1207  *
1208  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1209  *
1210  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1211  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1212  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1213  *	buffer size.
1214  *
1215  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1216  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1217  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1218  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1219  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1220  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1221  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1222  *
1223  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1224  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1225  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1226  *	determining the width and type.
1227  *
1228  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1229  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1230  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1231  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1232  *
1233  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1234  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1235  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1236  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1237  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1238  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1239  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1240  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1241  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1242  *	rate selection.
1243  *
1244  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1245  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1246  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1247  *
1248  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1249  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1250  *
1251  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1252  *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1253  *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1254  *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1255  *
1256  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1257  *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1258  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1259  *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1260  *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1261  *
1262  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1263  *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1264  *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1265  *
1266  * @NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION: This notification is sent out whenever
1267  *	mac80211/drv detects a bss color collision.
1268  *
1269  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST: This command is used to indicate that
1270  *	userspace wants to change the BSS color.
1271  *
1272  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED: Notify userland, that a color change has
1273  *	started
1274  *
1275  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED: Notify userland, that the color change has
1276  *	been aborted
1277  *
1278  * @NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED: Notify userland that the color change
1279  *	has completed
1280  *
1281  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD: Set FILS AAD data to the driver using -
1282  *	&NL80211_ATTR_MAC - for STA MAC address
1283  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - for KEK
1284  *	&NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES - for FILS Nonces
1285  *		(STA Nonce 16 bytes followed by AP Nonce 16 bytes)
1286  *
1287  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK: notification about an association
1288  *      temporal rejection with comeback. The event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
1289  *      to describe the BSSID address of the AP and %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT to
1290  *      specify the timeout value.
1291  *
1292  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK: Add a new link to an interface. The
1293  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID attribute is used for the new link.
1294  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK: Remove a link from an interface. This may come
1295  *	without %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID as an easy way to remove all links
1296  *	in preparation for e.g. roaming to a regular (non-MLO) AP.
1297  *
1298  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA: Add a link to an MLD station
1299  * @NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA: Modify a link of an MLD station
1300  * @NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA: Remove a link of an MLD station
1301  *
1302  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1303  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1304  */
1305 enum nl80211_commands {
1306 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1307 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1308 
1309 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1310 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1311 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1312 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1313 
1314 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1315 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1316 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1317 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1318 
1319 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1320 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1321 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1322 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1323 
1324 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1325 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1326 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1327 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1328 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1329 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1330 
1331 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1332 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1333 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1334 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1335 
1336 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1337 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1338 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1339 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1340 
1341 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1342 
1343 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1344 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1345 
1346 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1347 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1348 
1349 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1350 
1351 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1352 
1353 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1354 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1355 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1356 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1357 
1358 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1359 
1360 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1361 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1362 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1363 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1364 
1365 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1366 
1367 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1368 
1369 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1370 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1371 
1372 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1373 
1374 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1375 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1376 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1377 
1378 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1379 
1380 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1381 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1382 
1383 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1384 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1385 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1386 
1387 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1388 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1389 
1390 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1391 
1392 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1393 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1394 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1395 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1396 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1397 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1398 
1399 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1400 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1401 
1402 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1403 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1404 
1405 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1406 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1407 
1408 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1409 
1410 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1411 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1412 
1413 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1414 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1415 
1416 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1417 
1418 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1419 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1420 
1421 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1422 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1423 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1424 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1425 
1426 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1427 
1428 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1429 
1430 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1431 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1432 
1433 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1434 
1435 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1436 
1437 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1438 
1439 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1440 
1441 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1442 
1443 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1444 
1445 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1446 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1447 
1448 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1449 
1450 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1451 
1452 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1453 
1454 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1455 
1456 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1457 
1458 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1459 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1460 
1461 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1462 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1463 
1464 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1465 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1466 
1467 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1468 
1469 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1470 
1471 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1472 
1473 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1474 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1475 
1476 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1477 
1478 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1479 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1480 
1481 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1482 
1483 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1484 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1485 
1486 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1487 
1488 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1489 
1490 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1491 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1492 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1493 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1494 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1495 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1496 
1497 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1498 
1499 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1500 
1501 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1502 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1503 
1504 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1505 
1506 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1507 
1508 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1509 
1510 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1511 
1512 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1513 
1514 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1515 
1516 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1517 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1518 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1519 
1520 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1521 
1522 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1523 
1524 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1525 
1526 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1527 
1528 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1529 
1530 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1531 
1532 	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1533 
1534 	NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
1535 
1536 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_REQUEST,
1537 
1538 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
1539 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
1540 	NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
1541 
1542 	NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD,
1543 
1544 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOC_COMEBACK,
1545 
1546 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK,
1547 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK,
1548 
1549 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_LINK_STA,
1550 	NL80211_CMD_MODIFY_LINK_STA,
1551 	NL80211_CMD_REMOVE_LINK_STA,
1552 
1553 	/* add new commands above here */
1554 
1555 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1556 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1557 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1558 };
1559 
1560 /*
1561  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1562  * here
1563  */
1564 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1565 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1566 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1567 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1568 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1569 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1570 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1571 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1572 
1573 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1574 
1575 /* source-level API compatibility */
1576 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1577 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1578 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1579 
1580 /**
1581  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1582  *
1583  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1584  *
1585  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1586  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1587  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1588  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1589  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1590  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1591  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1592  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1593  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1594  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1595  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1596  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1597  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1598  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1599  *	operating channel center frequency.
1600  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1601  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1602  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1603  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1604  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1605  *		this attribute)
1606  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1607  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1608  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1609  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1610  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1611  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1612  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1613  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1614  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1615  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1616  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1617  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1618  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1619  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1620  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1621  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1622  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1623  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1624  *
1625  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1626  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1627  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1628  *
1629  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1630  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1631  *
1632  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1633  *
1634  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1635  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1636  *	keys
1637  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1638  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1639  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1640  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1641  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1642  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1643  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1644  *	default management key
1645  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1646  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1647  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1648  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1649  *
1650  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1651  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1652  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1653  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1654  *
1655  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1656  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1657  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1658  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1659  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1660  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1661  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1662  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1663  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1664  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1665  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1666  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1667  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1668  *
1669  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1670  *	consisting of a nested array.
1671  *
1672  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1673  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1674  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1675  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1676  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1677  * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1678  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1679  *
1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1681  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1682  *
1683  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1684  * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1685  * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1686  * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1687  * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1688  * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1689  * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1690  * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1691  * 	to a specific alpha2.
1692  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1693  *	rules.
1694  *
1695  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1696  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1697  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1698  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1699  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1700  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1701  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1702  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1703  *
1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1705  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1706  *
1707  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1708  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1709  *	of the interface mode.
1710  *
1711  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1712  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1713  *
1714  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1715  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1716  *
1717  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1718  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1719  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1720  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1721  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1722  *	that can be added to a scan request
1723  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1724  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1725  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1726  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1727  *
1728  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1729  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1730  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1731  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1732  *
1733  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1734  * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1735  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1736  * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1737  *
1738  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1739  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1740  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1741  *
1742  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1743  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1744  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1745  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1746  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1747  *	represented as a u32
1748  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1749  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1750  *
1751  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1752  *	a u32
1753  *
1754  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1755  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1756  * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1757  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1758  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1759  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1760  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1761  * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1762  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1763  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1764  *
1765  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1766  *	cipher suites
1767  *
1768  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1769  *	for other networks on different channels
1770  *
1771  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1772  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1773  *
1774  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1775  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1776  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1777  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1778  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1779  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1780  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1781  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1782  *
1783  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1784  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1785  *
1786  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1787  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1788  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1789  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1790  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1791  *	default in station mode.
1792  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1793  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1794  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1795  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1796  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1797  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1798  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1799  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1800  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1801  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1802  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1803  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1804  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1805  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1806  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1807  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1808  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1809  *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1810  *	frames are not forwared over the control port.
1811  *
1812  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1813  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1814  *
1815  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1816  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1817  *	a local disconnect request.
1818  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1819  *	event (u16)
1820  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1821  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1822  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1823  *
1824  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1825  *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1826  *	(an array of u32).
1827  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1828  *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1829  *	u32).
1830  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1831  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1832  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1833  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1834  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1835  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1836  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1837  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1838  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1839  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1840  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1841  *
1842  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1843  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1844  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1845  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1846  *
1847  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1848  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1849  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1850  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1851  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1852  *
1853  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1854  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1855  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1856  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1857  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1858  *
1859  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1860  *
1861  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1862  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1863  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1864  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1865  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1866  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1867  *	completely from scratch.
1868  *
1869  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1870  *
1871  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1872  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1873  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1874  *
1875  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1876  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1877  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1878  *
1879  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1880  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1881  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1882  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1883  *
1884  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1885  *
1886  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1887  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1888  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1889  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1890  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1891  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1892  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1893  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1894  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1895  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1896  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1897  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1898  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1899  *
1900  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1901  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1902  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1903  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1904  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1905  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1906  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1907  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1908  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1909  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1910  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1911  *
1912  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1913  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1914  *
1915  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1916  *
1917  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1918  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1919  *
1920  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1921  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1922  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1923  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1924  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1925  *
1926  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1927  *	connected to this BSS.
1928  *
1929  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1930  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1931  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1932  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1933  *      for non-automatic settings.
1934  *
1935  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1936  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1937  *
1938  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1939  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1940  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1941  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1942  *
1943  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1944  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1945  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1946  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1947  *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
1948  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1949  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1950  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
1951  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1952  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1953  *
1954  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1955  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1956  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1957  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1958  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1959  *
1960  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1961  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1962  *
1963  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1964  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1965  *
1966  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1967  *
1968  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
1969  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
1970  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
1971  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
1972  *	nl80211 capability flag.
1973  *
1974  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
1975  *
1976  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
1977  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
1978  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
1979  *
1980  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
1981  *	changed once the mesh is active.
1982  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
1983  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
1984  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
1985  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
1986  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
1987  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
1988  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
1989  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
1990  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
1991  *
1992  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
1993  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
1994  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
1995  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
1996  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
1997  *	triggers.
1998  *
1999  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
2000  *	cycles, in msecs.
2001  *
2002  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
2003  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
2004  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
2005  *	pass-thru filter rules.
2006  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
2007  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
2008  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
2009  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
2010  *	able to ignore them by itself.
2011  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
2012  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
2013  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
2014  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
2015  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
2016  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
2017  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
2018  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
2019  *
2020  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
2021  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
2022  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
2023  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
2024  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
2025  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
2026  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
2027  *
2028  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
2029  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
2030  *
2031  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
2032  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
2033  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
2034  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
2035  *
2036  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
2037  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
2038  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
2039  *
2040  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
2041  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
2042  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
2043  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
2044  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
2045  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
2046  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
2047  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
2048  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
2049  *
2050  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
2051  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
2052  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
2053  *	as AP.
2054  *
2055  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
2056  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
2057  *
2058  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
2059  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
2060  *
2061  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
2062  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
2063  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
2064  *	applications use this attribute.
2065  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
2066  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
2067  *
2068  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
2069  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
2070  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
2071  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
2072  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
2073  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
2074  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
2075  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
2076  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
2077  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
2078  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
2079  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
2080  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
2081  *
2082  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
2083  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
2084  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
2085  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
2086  *
2087  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
2088  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
2089  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
2090  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
2091  *
2092  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
2093  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
2094  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
2095  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
2096  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
2097  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
2098  *
2099  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
2100  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
2101  *	to be filled by the FW.
2102  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
2103  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2104  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2105  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
2106  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2107  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2108  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
2109  *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
2110  *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
2111  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
2112  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
2113  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
2114  *      The values that may be configured are:
2115  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
2116  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
2117  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
2118  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
2119  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
2120  *
2121  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
2122  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
2123  *    to one DFS region.
2124  *
2125  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
2126  *      up to 16 TIDs.
2127  *
2128  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
2129  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
2130  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
2131  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
2132  *	capability to timeout the stations.
2133  *
2134  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2135  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2136  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2137  *
2138  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2139  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2140  *
2141  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2142  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2143  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2144  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2145  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2146  *
2147  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2148  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2149  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2150  *
2151  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2152  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2153  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2154  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2155  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2156  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2157  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2158  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2159  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2160  *	consistent.
2161  *
2162  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2163  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2164  *
2165  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2166  *
2167  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2168  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2169  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2170  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2171  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2172  *	no change is made.
2173  *
2174  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2175  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2176  *
2177  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2178  *	carried in a u32 attribute
2179  *
2180  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2181  *	MAC ACL.
2182  *
2183  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2184  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2185  *	ACL.
2186  *
2187  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2188  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2189  *
2190  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2191  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2192  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2193  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2194  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2195  *
2196  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2197  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2198  *
2199  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2200  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2201  *	and PU-APSD.
2202  *
2203  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2204  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2205  *
2206  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2207  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2208  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2209  *
2210  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2211  *
2212  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2213  *	Element
2214  *
2215  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2216  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2217  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2218  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2219  *
2220  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2221  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2222  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2223  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2224  *
2225  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2226  *
2227  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2228  *	until the channel switch event.
2229  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2230  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2231  *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2232  *	was requested by the AP.
2233  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2234  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2235  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2236  *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2237  * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2238  *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2239  *
2240  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2241  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2242  *
2243  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2244  *
2245  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2246  *      operating classes.
2247  *
2248  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2249  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2250  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2251  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2252  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2253  *	IBSS network.
2254  *
2255  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2256  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2257  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2258  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2259  *
2260  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2261  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2262  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2263  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2264  *	u8 attribute.
2265  *
2266  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2267  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2268  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2269  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2270  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2271  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2272  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2273  *
2274  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2275  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2276  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2277  *
2278  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2279  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2280  *
2281  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2282  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2283  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2284  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2285  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2286  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2287  *
2288  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2289  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2290  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2291  *	supported number of csa counters.
2292  *
2293  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2294  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2295  *
2296  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2297  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2298  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2299  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2300  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2301  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2302  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2303  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2304  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2305  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2306  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2307  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2308  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2309  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2310  *	multicast group.
2311  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2312  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2313  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2314  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2315  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2316  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2317  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2318  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2319  *
2320  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2321  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2322  *
2323  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2324  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2325  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2326  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2327  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2328  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2329  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2330  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2331  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2332  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2333  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2334  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2335  *
2336  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2337  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2338  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2339  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2340  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2341  *
2342  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2343  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2344  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2345  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2346  *
2347  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2348  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2349  *
2350  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2351  *
2352  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2353  *
2354  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2355  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2356  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2357  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2358  *
2359  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2360  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2361  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2362  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2363  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2364  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2365  *
2366  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2367  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2368  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2369  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2370  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2371  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2372  *	over all channels.
2373  *
2374  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2375  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2376  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2377  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2378 
2379  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2380  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2381  *
2382  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2383  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2384  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2385  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2386  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2387  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2388  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2389  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2390  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2391  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2392  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2393  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2394  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2395  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2396  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2397  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2398  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2399  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2400  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2401  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2402  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2403  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2404  *
2405  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2406  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2407  *
2408  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2409  *
2410  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2411  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2412  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities and
2413  *	other interface-type specific capabilities per interface type. For MLO,
2414  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY and %NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS are
2415  *	present.
2416  *
2417  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2418  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2419  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2420  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2421  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2422  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2423  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2424  *	each group.
2425  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2426  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2427  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2428  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2429  *	groupID data.
2430  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2431  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2432  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2433  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2434  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2435  *
2436  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2437  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2438  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2439  *	attribute must not be included).
2440  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2441  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2442  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2443  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2444  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2445  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2446  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2447  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2448  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2449  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2450  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2451  *
2452  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2453  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2454  *
2455  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2456  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2457  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2458  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2459  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2460  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2461  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2462  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2463  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2464  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2465  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2466  *	the device will decide what to use.
2467  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2468  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2469  *	attribute.
2470  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2471  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2472  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2473  *	protection.
2474  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2475  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2476  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2477  *
2478  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2479  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2480  *
2481  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2482  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2483  *
2484  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2485  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2486  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2487  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2488  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2489  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2490  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2491  *
2492  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2493  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2494  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2495  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2496  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2497  *
2498  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2499  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2500  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2501  *
2502  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2503  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2504  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2505  *
2506  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2507  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2508  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2509  *
2510  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2511  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2512  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2513  *
2514  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2515  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2516  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2517  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2518  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2519  *
2520  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
2521  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2522  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2523  *
2524  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2525  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2526  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2527  *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2528  *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2529  *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2530  *	is included as well.
2531  *
2532  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2533  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2534  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2535  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2536  *
2537  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2538  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2539  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2540  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2541  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2542  *
2543  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2544  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2545  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2546  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2547  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2548  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2549  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2550  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2551  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space. (This flag
2552  *	attribute deprecated for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP, use
2553  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS)
2554  *
2555  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2556  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2557  *
2558  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2559  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2560  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2561  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2562  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2563  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2564  *      enforced.
2565  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2566  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2567  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2568  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2569  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2570  *
2571  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2572  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2573  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2574  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2575  *
2576  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2577  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2578  *
2579  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2580  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2581  *	invalid value.
2582  *
2583  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2584  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2585  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2586  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2587  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2588  *
2589  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2590  *	scheduler.
2591  *
2592  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2593  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2594  *	possible values.
2595  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2596  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2597  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2598  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2599  *	or per-station.
2600  *
2601  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2602  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2603  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2604  *
2605  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2606  *
2607  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2608  *	functionality.
2609  *
2610  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2611  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2612  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2613  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2614  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2615  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2616  *
2617  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2618  *	(u16).
2619  *
2620  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2621  *
2622  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2623  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2624  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2625  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2626  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2627  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2628  *
2629  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2630  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2631  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2632  *	attributes.
2633  *
2634  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2635  *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2636  *
2637  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2638  *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2639  *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2640  *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2641  *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2642  *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2643  *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2644  *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2645  *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2646  *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2647  *
2648  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2649  *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2650  *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2651  *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2652  *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2653  *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2654  *	has expired.
2655  *
2656  *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2657  *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2658  *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2659  *	disassociation is still forced.
2660  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2661  *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2662  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2663  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2664  *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2665  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2666  *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2667  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2668  *
2669  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2670  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2671  *
2672  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2673  *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2674  *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes.
2675  *
2676  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2677  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2678  *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes.
2679  *
2680  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2681  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2682  * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2683  *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2684  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2685  *
2686  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2687  *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2688  *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2689  *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2690  *
2691  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2692  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2693  *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2694  *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2695  *
2696  * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2697  *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2698  *	is desired.
2699  *
2700  * @NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap of the u64 BSS colors for the
2701  *	%NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION event.
2702  *
2703  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT: u8 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2704  *	until the color switch event.
2705  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR: u8 attribute specifying the color that we are
2706  *	switching to
2707  * @NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS: Nested set of attributes containing the IE
2708  *	information for the time while performing a color switch.
2709  *
2710  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG: Nested attribute for multiple BSSID
2711  *	advertisements (MBSSID) parameters in AP mode.
2712  *	Kernel uses this attribute to indicate the driver's support for MBSSID
2713  *	and enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP) to the userspace.
2714  *	Userspace should use this attribute to configure per interface MBSSID
2715  *	parameters.
2716  *	See &enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes for details.
2717  *
2718  * @NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS: Nested parameter to pass multiple BSSID elements.
2719  *	Mandatory parameter for the transmitting interface to enable MBSSID.
2720  *	Optional for the non-transmitting interfaces.
2721  *
2722  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Configure dedicated offchannel chain
2723  *	available for radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used
2724  *	to transmit or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
2725  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
2726  *	switching on a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
2727  *	radar channel.
2728  *
2729  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS: u32 attribute contains ap settings flags,
2730  *	enumerated in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags. This attribute shall be
2731  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request.
2732  *
2733  * @NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY: EHT Capability information element (from
2734  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2735  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2736  *
2737  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID: A (u8) link ID for use with MLO, to be used with
2738  *	various commands that need a link ID to operate.
2739  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS: A nested array of links, each containing some
2740  *	per-link information and a link ID.
2741  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR: An MLD address, used with various commands such as
2742  *	authenticate/associate.
2743  *
2744  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT: Flag attribute to indicate user space supports MLO
2745  *	connection. Used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. If this attribute is not
2746  *	included in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT drivers must not perform MLO connection.
2747  *
2748  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES: U16 attribute. Indicates maximum number of
2749  *	AKM suites allowed for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
2750  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_AP in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response. If this
2751  *	attribute is not present userspace shall consider maximum number of AKM
2752  *	suites allowed as %NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES which is the legacy maximum
2753  *	number prior to the introduction of this attribute.
2754  *
2755  * @NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY: EML Capability information (u16)
2756  * @NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS: MLD Capabilities and Operations (u16)
2757  *
2758  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for TX operation in
2759  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2760  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2761  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the frame TX
2762  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2763  *	the ack TX timestamp.
2764  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP: Hardware timestamp for RX operation in
2765  *	nanoseconds (u64). This is the device clock timestamp so it will
2766  *	probably reset when the device is stopped or the firmware is reset.
2767  *	When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS, indicates the ack RX
2768  *	timestamp. When used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME RX notification, indicates
2769  *	the incoming frame RX timestamp.
2770  * @NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP: Transition Disable bitmap, for subsequent
2771  *	(re)associations.
2772  *
2773  * @NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP: (u32) Preamble puncturing bitmap, lowest
2774  *	bit corresponds to the lowest 20 MHz channel. Each bit set to 1
2775  *	indicates that the sub-channel is punctured. Higher 16 bits are
2776  *	reserved.
2777  *
2778  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2779  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2780  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2781  */
2782 enum nl80211_attrs {
2783 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2784 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2785 
2786 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2787 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2788 
2789 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2790 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2791 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2792 
2793 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2794 
2795 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2796 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2797 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2798 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2799 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2800 
2801 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2802 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2803 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2804 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2805 
2806 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2807 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2808 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2809 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2810 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2811 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2812 
2813 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2814 
2815 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2816 
2817 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2818 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2819 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2820 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2821 
2822 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2823 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2824 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2825 
2826 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2827 
2828 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2829 
2830 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2831 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2832 
2833 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2834 
2835 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2836 
2837 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2838 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2839 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2840 
2841 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2842 
2843 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2844 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2845 
2846 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2847 
2848 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2849 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2850 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2851 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2852 
2853 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2854 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2855 
2856 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2857 
2858 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2859 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2860 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2861 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2862 
2863 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2864 
2865 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2866 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2867 
2868 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2869 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2870 
2871 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2872 
2873 
2874 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2875 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2876 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2877 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2878 
2879 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2880 
2881 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2882 
2883 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2884 
2885 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2886 
2887 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2888 
2889 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2890 
2891 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2892 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2893 
2894 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2895 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2896 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2897 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2898 
2899 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2900 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2901 
2902 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2903 
2904 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2905 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2906 
2907 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2908 
2909 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2910 
2911 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2912 
2913 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2914 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2915 
2916 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2917 
2918 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
2919 
2920 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
2921 
2922 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
2923 
2924 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
2925 
2926 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
2927 
2928 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
2929 
2930 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
2931 
2932 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
2933 
2934 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
2935 
2936 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2937 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
2938 
2939 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
2940 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
2941 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
2942 
2943 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
2944 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
2945 
2946 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
2947 
2948 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
2949 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
2950 
2951 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
2952 
2953 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
2954 
2955 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
2956 
2957 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
2958 
2959 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
2960 
2961 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
2962 
2963 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
2964 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
2965 
2966 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
2967 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
2968 
2969 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
2970 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
2971 
2972 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
2973 
2974 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
2975 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
2976 
2977 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
2978 
2979 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
2980 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2981 
2982 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
2983 
2984 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
2985 
2986 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
2987 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
2988 
2989 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
2990 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
2991 
2992 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
2993 
2994 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
2995 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
2996 
2997 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
2998 
2999 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
3000 
3001 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
3002 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
3003 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
3004 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
3005 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
3006 
3007 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
3008 
3009 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
3010 
3011 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
3012 
3013 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
3014 
3015 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
3016 
3017 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
3018 
3019 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
3020 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3021 
3022 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
3023 
3024 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
3025 
3026 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
3027 
3028 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
3029 
3030 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
3031 
3032 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
3033 
3034 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
3035 
3036 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
3037 
3038 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
3039 
3040 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
3041 
3042 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
3043 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
3044 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
3045 
3046 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
3047 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
3048 
3049 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
3050 
3051 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
3052 
3053 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
3054 
3055 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
3056 
3057 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
3058 
3059 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
3060 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
3061 
3062 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
3063 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
3064 
3065 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
3066 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
3067 
3068 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
3069 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3070 
3071 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
3072 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
3073 
3074 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
3075 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
3076 
3077 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
3078 
3079 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
3080 
3081 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
3082 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
3083 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
3084 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
3085 	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
3086 
3087 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
3088 
3089 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
3090 
3091 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
3092 
3093 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
3094 
3095 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
3096 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
3097 
3098 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
3099 
3100 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
3101 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
3102 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
3103 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
3104 
3105 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
3106 
3107 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
3108 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
3109 
3110 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
3111 
3112 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
3113 
3114 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
3115 
3116 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
3117 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
3118 
3119 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
3120 
3121 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
3122 
3123 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
3124 
3125 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
3126 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
3127 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
3128 
3129 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
3130 
3131 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
3132 
3133 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
3134 
3135 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
3136 
3137 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
3138 
3139 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
3140 
3141 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
3142 
3143 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
3144 
3145 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
3146 
3147 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3148 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
3149 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
3150 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
3151 
3152 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
3153 
3154 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
3155 
3156 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
3157 
3158 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
3159 
3160 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
3161 
3162 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
3163 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
3164 
3165 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
3166 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
3167 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
3168 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
3169 
3170 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
3171 
3172 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
3173 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
3174 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
3175 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
3176 
3177 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
3178 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
3179 
3180 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
3181 
3182 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
3183 
3184 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3185 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
3186 
3187 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
3188 
3189 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
3190 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
3191 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
3192 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
3193 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
3194 
3195 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
3196 
3197 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
3198 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
3199 
3200 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
3201 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
3202 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
3203 
3204 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
3205 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
3206 
3207 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
3208 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
3209 
3210 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
3211 
3212 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
3213 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
3214 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3215 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3216 
3217 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3218 
3219 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3220 
3221 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3222 
3223 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3224 
3225 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3226 
3227 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3228 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3229 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3230 
3231 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3232 
3233 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3234 
3235 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3236 
3237 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3238 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3239 
3240 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3241 
3242 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3243 
3244 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3245 
3246 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3247 
3248 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3249 
3250 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3251 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3252 
3253 	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3254 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3255 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3256 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3257 
3258 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3259 
3260 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3261 
3262 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3263 
3264 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3265 	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3266 
3267 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3268 
3269 	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3270 
3271 	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3272 
3273 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3274 
3275 	NL80211_ATTR_OBSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
3276 
3277 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COUNT,
3278 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_COLOR,
3279 	NL80211_ATTR_COLOR_CHANGE_ELEMS,
3280 
3281 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_CONFIG,
3282 	NL80211_ATTR_MBSSID_ELEMS,
3283 
3284 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
3285 
3286 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_SETTINGS_FLAGS,
3287 
3288 	NL80211_ATTR_EHT_CAPABILITY,
3289 
3290 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_EHT,
3291 
3292 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINKS,
3293 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_LINK_ID,
3294 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_ADDR,
3295 
3296 	NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT,
3297 
3298 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES,
3299 
3300 	NL80211_ATTR_EML_CAPABILITY,
3301 	NL80211_ATTR_MLD_CAPA_AND_OPS,
3302 
3303 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3304 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_HW_TIMESTAMP,
3305 	NL80211_ATTR_TD_BITMAP,
3306 
3307 	NL80211_ATTR_PUNCT_BITMAP,
3308 
3309 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3310 
3311 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3312 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3313 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3314 };
3315 
3316 /* source-level API compatibility */
3317 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3318 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3319 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3320 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3321 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3322 #define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3323 
3324 /*
3325  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3326  * here
3327  */
3328 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3329 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3330 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3331 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3332 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3333 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3334 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3335 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3336 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3337 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3338 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3339 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3340 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3341 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3342 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3343 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3344 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3345 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3346 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3347 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3348 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3349 
3350 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3351 
3352 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3353 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3354 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3355 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3356 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3357 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3358 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3359 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3360 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3361 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3362 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3363 
3364 /*
3365  * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES is obsolete when %NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES
3366  * present in %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY response.
3367  */
3368 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3369 #define NL80211_EHT_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN          13
3370 #define NL80211_EHT_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN          51
3371 
3372 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3373 
3374 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3375 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3376 
3377 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3378 
3379 /**
3380  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3381  *
3382  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3383  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3384  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3385  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3386  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3387  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3388  *	AP type interface.
3389  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3390  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3391  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3392  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3393  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3394  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3395  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3396  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3397  *	commands to create and destroy one
3398  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3399  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3400  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3401  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3402  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3403  *
3404  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3405  * to set the type of an interface.
3406  *
3407  */
3408 enum nl80211_iftype {
3409 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3410 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3411 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3412 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3413 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3414 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3415 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3416 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3417 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3418 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3419 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3420 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3421 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3422 
3423 	/* keep last */
3424 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3425 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3426 };
3427 
3428 /**
3429  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3430  *
3431  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3432  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3433  *
3434  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3435  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3436  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3437  *	with short barker preamble
3438  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3439  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3440  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3441  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3442  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3443  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3444  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3445  *	as errors.)
3446  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3447  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3448  *	previously added station into associated state
3449  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3450  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3451  */
3452 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3453 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3454 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3455 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3456 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3457 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3458 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3459 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3460 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3461 
3462 	/* keep last */
3463 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3464 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3465 };
3466 
3467 /**
3468  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3469  *
3470  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3471  * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3472  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3473  */
3474 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3475 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3476 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3477 
3478 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3479 };
3480 
3481 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3482 
3483 /**
3484  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3485  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3486  * @set: which values to set them to
3487  *
3488  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3489  */
3490 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3491 	__u32 mask;
3492 	__u32 set;
3493 } __attribute__((packed));
3494 
3495 /**
3496  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3497  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3498  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3499  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3500  */
3501 enum nl80211_he_gi {
3502 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3503 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3504 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3505 };
3506 
3507 /**
3508  * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3509  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec
3510  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec
3511  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec
3512  */
3513 enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3514 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3515 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3516 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3517 };
3518 
3519 /**
3520  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3521  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3522  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3523  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3524  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3525  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3526  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3527  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3528  */
3529 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3530 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3531 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3532 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3533 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3534 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3535 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3536 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3537 };
3538 
3539 /**
3540  * enum nl80211_eht_gi - EHT guard interval
3541  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3542  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3543  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3544  */
3545 enum nl80211_eht_gi {
3546 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_0_8,
3547 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_1_6,
3548 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI_3_2,
3549 };
3550 
3551 /**
3552  * enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc - EHT RU allocation values
3553  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3554  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3555  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26: 52+26-tone RU allocation
3556  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3557  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26: 106+26 tone RU allocation
3558  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3559  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3560  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242: 484+242 tone RU allocation
3561  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3562  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484: 996+484 tone RU allocation
3563  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242: 996+484+242 tone RU allocation
3564  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3565  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484: 2x996+484 tone RU allocation
3566  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996: 3x996-tone RU allocation
3567  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484: 3x996+484 tone RU allocation
3568  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996: 4x996-tone RU allocation
3569  */
3570 enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc {
3571 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_26,
3572 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52,
3573 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_52P26,
3574 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106,
3575 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_106P26,
3576 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_242,
3577 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484,
3578 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_484P242,
3579 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996,
3580 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484,
3581 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_996P484P242,
3582 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3583 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_2x996P484,
3584 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996,
3585 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_3x996P484,
3586 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC_4x996,
3587 };
3588 
3589 /**
3590  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3591  *
3592  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3593  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3594  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3595  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3596  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3597  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3598  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3599  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3600  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3601  *
3602  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3603  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3604  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3605  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3606  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3607  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3608  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3609  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3610  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3611  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3612  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3613  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3614  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3615  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3616  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3617  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3618  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3619  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3620  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3621  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3622  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3623  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3624  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3625  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3626  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3627  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3628  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH: 320 MHz bitrate
3629  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS index (u8, 0-15)
3630  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS: EHT NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3631  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI: EHT guard interval identifier
3632  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
3633  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC: EHT RU allocation, if not present then
3634  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc)
3635  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3636  */
3637 enum nl80211_rate_info {
3638 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3639 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3640 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3641 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3642 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3643 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3644 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3645 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3646 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3647 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3648 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3649 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3650 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3651 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3652 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3653 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3654 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3655 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3656 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_320_MHZ_WIDTH,
3657 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_MCS,
3658 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_NSS,
3659 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_GI,
3660 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_EHT_RU_ALLOC,
3661 
3662 	/* keep last */
3663 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3664 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3665 };
3666 
3667 /**
3668  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3669  *
3670  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3671  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3672  *
3673  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3674  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3675  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3676  *	(flag)
3677  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3678  *	(flag)
3679  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3680  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3681  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3682  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3683  */
3684 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3685 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3686 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3687 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3688 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3689 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3690 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3691 
3692 	/* keep last */
3693 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3694 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3695 };
3696 
3697 /**
3698  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3699  *
3700  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3701  * when getting information about a station.
3702  *
3703  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3704  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3705  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3706  *	(u32, from this station)
3707  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3708  *	(u32, to this station)
3709  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3710  *	(u64, from this station)
3711  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3712  *	(u64, to this station)
3713  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3714  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3715  * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3716  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3717  *	(u32, from this station)
3718  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3719  *	(u32, to this station)
3720  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3721  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3722  *	(u32, to this station)
3723  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3724  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3725  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3726  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3727  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3728  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3729  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3730  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3731  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3732  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3733  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3734  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3735  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3736  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3737  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3738  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3739  *	non-peer STA
3740  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3741  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3742  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3743  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3744  * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
3745  *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3746  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3747  *	(u64)
3748  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3749  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3750  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3751  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3752  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3753  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3754  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3755  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3756  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3757  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3758  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3759  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3760  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3761  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3762  *	(u32, from this station)
3763  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3764  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3765  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3766  *	might not be fully accurate.
3767  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3768  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3769  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3770  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3771  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3772  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3773  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3774  *	of STA's association
3775  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3776  *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3777  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3778  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3779  */
3780 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3781 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3782 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3783 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3784 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3785 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3786 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3787 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3788 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3789 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3790 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3791 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3792 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3793 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3794 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3795 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3796 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3797 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3798 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3799 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3800 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3801 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3802 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3803 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3804 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3805 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3806 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3807 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3808 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3809 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3810 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3811 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3812 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3813 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3814 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3815 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3816 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3817 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3818 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3819 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3820 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3821 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3822 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3823 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3824 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3825 
3826 	/* keep last */
3827 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3828 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3829 };
3830 
3831 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3832 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3833 
3834 
3835 /**
3836  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3837  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3838  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3839  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3840  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3841  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3842  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3843  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3844  *	MSDUs (u64)
3845  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3846  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3847  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3848  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3849  */
3850 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3851 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3852 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3853 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3854 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3855 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3856 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3857 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3858 
3859 	/* keep last */
3860 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3861 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3862 };
3863 
3864 /**
3865  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3866  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3867  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3868  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3869  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3870  *      backlogged
3871  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3872  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3873  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3874  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3875  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3876  *      (only for per-phy stats)
3877  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3878  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3879  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3880  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3881  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3882  */
3883 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3884 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3885 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3886 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3887 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3888 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
3889 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
3890 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
3891 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
3892 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
3893 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
3894 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
3895 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
3896 
3897 	/* keep last */
3898 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
3899 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
3900 };
3901 
3902 /**
3903  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
3904  *
3905  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
3906  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
3907  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
3908  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
3909  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
3910  */
3911 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
3912 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
3913 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
3914 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
3915 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
3916 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
3917 };
3918 
3919 /**
3920  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
3921  *
3922  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
3923  * information about a mesh path.
3924  *
3925  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3926  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
3927  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
3928  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
3929  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
3930  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
3931  * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
3932  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
3933  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
3934  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
3935  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
3936  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
3937  *	currently defined
3938  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3939  */
3940 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
3941 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
3942 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
3943 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
3944 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
3945 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
3946 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
3947 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
3948 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
3949 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
3950 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
3951 
3952 	/* keep last */
3953 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3954 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3955 };
3956 
3957 /**
3958  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
3959  *
3960  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3961  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
3962  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
3963  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
3964  *     capabilities IE
3965  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
3966  *     capabilities IE
3967  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
3968  *     capabilities IE
3969  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
3970  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
3971  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
3972  *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
3973  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS: vendor element capabilities that are
3974  *	advertised on this band/for this iftype (binary)
3975  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC: EHT MAC capabilities as in EHT
3976  *	capabilities element
3977  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY: EHT PHY capabilities as in EHT
3978  *	capabilities element
3979  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET: EHT supported NSS/MCS as in EHT
3980  *	capabilities element
3981  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE: EHT PPE thresholds information as
3982  *	defined in EHT capabilities element
3983  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3984  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
3985  */
3986 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
3987 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
3988 
3989 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
3990 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
3991 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
3992 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
3993 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
3994 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
3995 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_VENDOR_ELEMS,
3996 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MAC,
3997 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PHY,
3998 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_MCS_SET,
3999 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_EHT_CAP_PPE,
4000 
4001 	/* keep last */
4002 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4003 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4004 };
4005 
4006 /**
4007  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
4008  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4009  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
4010  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
4011  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
4012  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
4013  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4014  *	defined in 802.11n
4015  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4016  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
4017  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
4018  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
4019  *	defined in 802.11ac
4020  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
4021  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
4022  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
4023  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
4024  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
4025  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
4026  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
4027  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
4028  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
4029  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
4030  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4031  */
4032 enum nl80211_band_attr {
4033 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
4034 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
4035 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
4036 
4037 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
4038 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
4039 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
4040 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
4041 
4042 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
4043 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
4044 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
4045 
4046 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
4047 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
4048 
4049 	/* keep last */
4050 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4051 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4052 };
4053 
4054 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
4055 
4056 /**
4057  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
4058  *
4059  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4060  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
4061  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
4062  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
4063  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
4064  * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
4065  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
4066  */
4067 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
4068 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
4069 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
4070 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
4071 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
4072 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
4073 
4074 	/* keep last */
4075 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
4076 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
4077 };
4078 
4079 /**
4080  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
4081  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4082  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
4083  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
4084  *	regulatory domain.
4085  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
4086  * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
4087  * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
4088  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
4089  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4090  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
4091  *	(100 * dBm).
4092  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
4093  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
4094  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
4095  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
4096  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
4097  *	channel as the control channel
4098  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
4099  *	channel as the control channel
4100  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
4101  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
4102  *	this includes 80+80 channels
4103  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
4104  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
4105  *	isn't possible
4106  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4107  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
4108  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
4109  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
4110  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
4111  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
4112  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
4113  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
4114  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
4115  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
4116  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
4117  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
4118  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
4119  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
4120  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
4121  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
4122  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
4123  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
4124  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
4125  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4126  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
4127  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4128  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
4129  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
4130  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
4131  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
4132  *	in current regulatory domain.
4133  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4134  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
4135  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4136  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
4137  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4138  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
4139  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4140  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
4141  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4142  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
4143  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
4144  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ: any 320 MHz channel using this channel
4145  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible
4146  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not allowed on this channel
4147  *	in current regulatory domain.
4148  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
4149  *	currently defined
4150  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4151  *
4152  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
4153  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
4154  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
4155  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
4156  */
4157 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
4158 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
4159 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
4160 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
4161 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
4162 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
4163 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
4164 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
4165 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
4166 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
4167 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
4168 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
4169 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
4170 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
4171 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4172 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
4173 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
4174 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
4175 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
4176 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
4177 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
4178 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
4179 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
4180 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
4181 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
4182 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
4183 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
4184 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_320MHZ,
4185 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_EHT,
4186 
4187 	/* keep last */
4188 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4189 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4190 };
4191 
4192 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
4193 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4194 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4195 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
4196 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
4197 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4198 
4199 /**
4200  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
4201  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4202  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
4203  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
4204  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
4205  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
4206  *	currently defined
4207  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4208  */
4209 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
4210 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
4211 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
4212 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
4213 
4214 	/* keep last */
4215 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4216 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4217 };
4218 
4219 /**
4220  * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
4221  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
4222  * 	regulatory domain.
4223  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
4224  * 	regulatory domain.
4225  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
4226  * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
4227  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
4228  * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
4229  * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
4230  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
4231  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
4232  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
4233  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
4234  */
4235 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
4236 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
4237 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
4238 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
4239 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
4240 };
4241 
4242 /**
4243  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
4244  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
4245  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
4246  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
4247  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
4248  * 	domain.
4249  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
4250  * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
4251  * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
4252  * 	them to be applied.
4253  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
4254  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
4255  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
4256  *	domain request to be processed.
4257  */
4258 enum nl80211_reg_type {
4259 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
4260 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
4261 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
4262 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
4263 };
4264 
4265 /**
4266  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
4267  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4268  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
4269  * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
4270  * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
4271  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
4272  * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
4273  * 	band edge.
4274  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
4275  * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
4276  * 	band edge.
4277  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
4278  *	frequency range, in KHz.
4279  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
4280  * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
4281  * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
4282  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
4283  * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
4284  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
4285  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
4286  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
4287  *	currently defined
4288  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4289  */
4290 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
4291 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
4292 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
4293 
4294 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
4295 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
4296 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
4297 
4298 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
4299 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
4300 
4301 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
4302 
4303 	/* keep last */
4304 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4305 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4306 };
4307 
4308 /**
4309  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
4310  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4311  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
4312  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
4313  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
4314  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
4315  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
4316  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
4317  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
4318  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
4319  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
4320  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
4321  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
4322  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
4323  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
4324  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
4325  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
4326  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
4327  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
4328  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
4329  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
4330  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
4331  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the
4332  *	band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in
4333  *	enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a
4334  *	band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one
4335  *	of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the
4336  *	minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated
4337  *	within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such
4338  *	attributes will be nested within this attribute.
4339  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4340  *	attribute number currently defined
4341  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4342  */
4343 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4344 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4345 
4346 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4347 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4348 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4349 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4350 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4351 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI,
4352 
4353 	/* keep last */
4354 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4355 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4356 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4357 };
4358 
4359 /* only for backward compatibility */
4360 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4361 
4362 /**
4363  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4364  *
4365  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4366  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4367  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4368  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4369  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4370  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4371  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4372  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4373  * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4374  * 	beaconing.
4375  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4376  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4377  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4378  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4379  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4380  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4381  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4382  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4383  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4384  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ: 320MHz operation not allowed
4385  */
4386 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4387 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4388 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4389 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4390 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4391 	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4392 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4393 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4394 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4395 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4396 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4397 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4398 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4399 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4400 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4401 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4402 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4403 	NL80211_RRF_NO_320MHZ		= 1<<18,
4404 };
4405 
4406 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4407 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4408 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4409 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4410 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4411 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4412 
4413 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4414 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4415 
4416 /**
4417  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4418  *
4419  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4420  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4421  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4422  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4423  */
4424 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4425 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4426 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4427 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4428 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4429 };
4430 
4431 /**
4432  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4433  *
4434  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4435  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4436  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4437  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4438  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4439  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4440  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4441  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4442  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4443  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4444  *	supported feature.
4445  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4446  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4447  */
4448 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4449 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4450 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4451 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4452 };
4453 
4454 /**
4455  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4456  *
4457  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4458  * when getting information about a survey.
4459  *
4460  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4461  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4462  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4463  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4464  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4465  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4466  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4467  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4468  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4469  *	channel was sensed busy
4470  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4471  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4472  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4473  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4474  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4475  *	(on this channel or globally)
4476  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4477  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4478  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4479  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4480  *	currently defined
4481  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4482  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4483  */
4484 enum nl80211_survey_info {
4485 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4486 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4487 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4488 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4489 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4490 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4491 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4492 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4493 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4494 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4495 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4496 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4497 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4498 
4499 	/* keep last */
4500 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4501 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4502 };
4503 
4504 /* keep old names for compatibility */
4505 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4506 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4507 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4508 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4509 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4510 
4511 /**
4512  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4513  *
4514  * Monitor configuration flags.
4515  *
4516  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4517  *
4518  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4519  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4520  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4521  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4522  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4523  *	overrides all other flags.
4524  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4525  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4526  *
4527  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4528  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4529  */
4530 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4531 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4532 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4533 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4534 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4535 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4536 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4537 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4538 
4539 	/* keep last */
4540 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4541 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4542 };
4543 
4544 /**
4545  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4546  *
4547  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4548  *	not known or has not been set yet.
4549  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4550  *	in Awake state all the time.
4551  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4552  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4553  *	neighbor's beacons.
4554  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4555  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4556  *	for neighbor's beacons.
4557  *
4558  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
4559  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
4560  */
4561 
4562 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4563 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4564 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4565 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4566 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4567 
4568 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4569 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4570 };
4571 
4572 /**
4573  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4574  *
4575  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4576  * active.
4577  *
4578  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4579  *
4580  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4581  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4582  *
4583  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4584  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4585  *
4586  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4587  *	millisecond units
4588  *
4589  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4590  *	on this mesh interface
4591  *
4592  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4593  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4594  *	mesh
4595  *
4596  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4597  *	point.
4598  *
4599  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4600  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4601  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4602  *	set.
4603  *
4604  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4605  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4606  *	target)
4607  *
4608  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4609  *	(in milliseconds)
4610  *
4611  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4612  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4613  *
4614  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4615  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4616  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4617  *
4618  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4619  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4620  *	reference element
4621  *
4622  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4623  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4624  *	mesh
4625  *
4626  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4627  *
4628  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4629  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4630  *
4631  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4632  *	root announcements are transmitted.
4633  *
4634  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4635  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4636  *	Announcement frames.
4637  *
4638  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4639  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4640  *	PERR element.
4641  *
4642  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4643  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4644  *
4645  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4646  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4647  *	a peer link.
4648  *
4649  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4650  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4651  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4652  *
4653  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4654  *
4655  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4656  *
4657  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4658  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4659  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4660  *
4661  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4662  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4663  *
4664  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4665  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4666  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4667  *
4668  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4669  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4670  *
4671  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4672  *
4673  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4674  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4675  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4676  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4677  *
4678  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4679  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4680  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4681  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4682  *
4683  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4684  *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4685  *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4686  *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4687  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4688  *
4689  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4690  *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4691  *	in the mesh formation field.
4692  *
4693  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4694  */
4695 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4696 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4697 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4698 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4699 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4700 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4701 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4702 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4703 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4704 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4705 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4706 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4707 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4708 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4709 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4710 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4711 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4712 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4713 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4714 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4715 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4716 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4717 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4718 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4719 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4720 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4721 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4722 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4723 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4724 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4725 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4726 	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4727 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4728 
4729 	/* keep last */
4730 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4731 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4732 };
4733 
4734 /**
4735  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4736  *
4737  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4738  * changed while the mesh is active.
4739  *
4740  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4741  *
4742  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4743  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4744  *	default HWMP.
4745  *
4746  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4747  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4748  *	metric.
4749  *
4750  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4751  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4752  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4753  *	metrics in use.
4754  *
4755  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4756  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4757  *
4758  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4759  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4760  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4761  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4762  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4763  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4764  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4765  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4766  *	userspace daemon.
4767  *
4768  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4769  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4770  *	neighbor offset synchronization
4771  *
4772  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4773  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4774  *
4775  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4776  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4777  *	Default is no authentication method required.
4778  *
4779  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4780  *
4781  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4782  */
4783 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4784 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4785 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4786 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4787 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4788 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4789 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4790 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4791 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4792 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4793 
4794 	/* keep last */
4795 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4796 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4797 };
4798 
4799 /**
4800  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4801  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4802  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4803  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4804  *	disabled
4805  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4806  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4807  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4808  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4809  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4810  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4811  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4812  */
4813 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4814 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4815 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4816 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4817 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4818 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4819 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4820 
4821 	/* keep last */
4822 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4823 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4824 };
4825 
4826 enum nl80211_ac {
4827 	NL80211_AC_VO,
4828 	NL80211_AC_VI,
4829 	NL80211_AC_BE,
4830 	NL80211_AC_BK,
4831 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
4832 };
4833 
4834 /* backward compat */
4835 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
4836 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
4837 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
4838 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
4839 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
4840 
4841 /**
4842  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
4843  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4844  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
4845  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4846  *	below the control channel
4847  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4848  *	above the control channel
4849  */
4850 enum nl80211_channel_type {
4851 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
4852 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
4853 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
4854 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
4855 };
4856 
4857 /**
4858  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
4859  *
4860  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
4861  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
4862  *
4863  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
4864  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
4865  *
4866  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
4867  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
4868  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
4869  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
4870  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
4871  */
4872 enum nl80211_key_mode {
4873 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
4874 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
4875 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
4876 };
4877 
4878 /**
4879  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
4880  *
4881  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
4882  * attribute.
4883  *
4884  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4885  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
4886  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4887  *	attribute must be provided as well
4888  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4889  *	attribute must be provided as well
4890  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4891  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
4892  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4893  *	attribute must be provided as well
4894  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
4895  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
4896  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
4897  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
4898  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
4899  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
4900  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
4901  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320: 320 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4902  *	attribute must be provided as well
4903  */
4904 enum nl80211_chan_width {
4905 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
4906 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4907 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
4908 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
4909 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
4910 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
4911 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4912 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4913 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4914 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4915 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
4916 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
4917 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
4918 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320,
4919 };
4920 
4921 /**
4922  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
4923  *
4924  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
4925  *
4926  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
4927  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
4928  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
4929  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
4930  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
4931  */
4932 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
4933 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4934 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4935 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4936 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4937 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4938 };
4939 
4940 /**
4941  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
4942  *
4943  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
4944  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
4945  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
4946  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
4947  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
4948  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
4949  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
4950  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
4951  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
4952  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
4953  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
4954  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
4955  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
4956  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
4957  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
4958  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
4959  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
4960  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
4961  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
4962  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
4963  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
4964  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
4965  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
4966  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
4967  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
4968  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
4969  *	yet been received
4970  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
4971  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width)
4972  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
4973  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
4974  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
4975  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
4976  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
4977  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
4978  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
4979  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4980  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
4981  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
4982  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
4983  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
4984  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
4985  *	is set.
4986  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
4987  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
4988  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
4989  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4990  * @NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID: MLO link ID of the BSS (u8).
4991  * @NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR: MLD address of this BSS if connected to it.
4992  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
4993  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
4994  */
4995 enum nl80211_bss {
4996 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
4997 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
4998 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
4999 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
5000 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
5001 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
5002 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
5003 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
5004 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
5005 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
5006 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
5007 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
5008 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
5009 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
5010 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
5011 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
5012 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
5013 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5014 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
5015 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
5016 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
5017 	NL80211_BSS_MLO_LINK_ID,
5018 	NL80211_BSS_MLD_ADDR,
5019 
5020 	/* keep last */
5021 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
5022 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5023 };
5024 
5025 /**
5026  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
5027  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
5028  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
5029  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
5030  *	a given BSS.
5031  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
5032  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
5033  *
5034  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
5035  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
5036  */
5037 enum nl80211_bss_status {
5038 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
5039 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
5040 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
5041 };
5042 
5043 /**
5044  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
5045  *
5046  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
5047  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
5048  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
5049  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
5050  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
5051  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
5052  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
5053  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
5054  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
5055  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
5056  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
5057  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
5058  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
5059  */
5060 enum nl80211_auth_type {
5061 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
5062 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
5063 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
5064 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
5065 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
5066 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
5067 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
5068 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
5069 
5070 	/* keep last */
5071 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
5072 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
5073 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
5074 };
5075 
5076 /**
5077  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
5078  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
5079  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
5080  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
5081  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
5082  */
5083 enum nl80211_key_type {
5084 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
5085 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
5086 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
5087 
5088 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
5089 };
5090 
5091 /**
5092  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
5093  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
5094  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
5095  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
5096  */
5097 enum nl80211_mfp {
5098 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
5099 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
5100 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5101 };
5102 
5103 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
5104 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
5105 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
5106 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
5107 };
5108 
5109 /**
5110  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
5111  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
5112  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
5113  *	unicast key
5114  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
5115  *	multicast key
5116  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
5117  */
5118 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
5119 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
5120 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
5121 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
5122 
5123 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
5124 };
5125 
5126 /**
5127  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
5128  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
5129  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
5130  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
5131  *	keys
5132  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
5133  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
5134  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
5135  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
5136  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
5137  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
5138  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
5139  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
5140  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
5141  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
5142  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
5143  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
5144  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
5145  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
5146  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
5147  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
5148  *
5149  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
5150  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
5151  */
5152 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
5153 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
5154 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
5155 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
5156 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
5157 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
5158 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
5159 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
5160 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
5161 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
5162 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
5163 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
5164 
5165 	/* keep last */
5166 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
5167 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
5168 };
5169 
5170 /**
5171  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
5172  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
5173  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5174  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
5175  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
5176  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
5177  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
5178  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
5179  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5180  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
5181  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
5182  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
5183  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
5184  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
5185  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
5186  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
5187  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
5188  */
5189 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
5190 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
5191 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
5192 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
5193 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
5194 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
5195 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
5196 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
5197 	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
5198 
5199 	/* keep last */
5200 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
5201 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
5202 };
5203 
5204 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
5205 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
5206 
5207 /**
5208  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5209  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5210  */
5211 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
5212 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
5213 };
5214 
5215 #define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
5216 /**
5217  * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
5218  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
5219  */
5220 struct nl80211_txrate_he {
5221 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
5222 };
5223 
5224 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
5225 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
5226 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
5227 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
5228 };
5229 
5230 /**
5231  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
5232  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
5233  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
5234  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
5235  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
5236  * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
5237  * @NL80211_BAND_LC: light communication band (placeholder)
5238  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
5239  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
5240  */
5241 enum nl80211_band {
5242 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
5243 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
5244 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
5245 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
5246 	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
5247 	NL80211_BAND_LC,
5248 
5249 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
5250 };
5251 
5252 /**
5253  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
5254  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
5255  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
5256  */
5257 enum nl80211_ps_state {
5258 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
5259 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
5260 };
5261 
5262 /**
5263  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
5264  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
5265  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
5266  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
5267  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
5268  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
5269  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
5270  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
5271  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
5272  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
5273  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
5274  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
5275  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
5276  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
5277  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
5278  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
5279  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
5280  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
5281  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
5282  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
5283  *	checked.
5284  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
5285  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
5286  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
5287  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
5288  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
5289  *	loss event
5290  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
5291  *	RSSI threshold event.
5292  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
5293  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
5294  */
5295 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
5296 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
5297 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
5298 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
5299 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
5300 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
5301 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
5302 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
5303 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
5304 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5305 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
5306 
5307 	/* keep last */
5308 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
5309 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
5310 };
5311 
5312 /**
5313  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
5314  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
5315  *      configured threshold
5316  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
5317  *      configured threshold
5318  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
5319  */
5320 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
5321 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
5322 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
5323 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
5324 };
5325 
5326 
5327 /**
5328  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
5329  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
5330  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
5331  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
5332  */
5333 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
5334 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
5335 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
5336 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
5337 };
5338 
5339 /**
5340  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
5341  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
5342  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
5343  */
5344 enum nl80211_tid_config {
5345 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
5346 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
5347 };
5348 
5349 /* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5350  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5351  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5352  * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5353  */
5354 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5355 	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5356 	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5357 	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5358 };
5359 
5360 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5361  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5362  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5363  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5364  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5365  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5366  *	per peer instead.
5367  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates
5368  *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5369  *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5370  *	should be left untouched.
5371  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5372  *	Its type is u16.
5373  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5374  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5375  *	Its type is u8.
5376  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5377  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5378  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5379  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5380  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5381  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5382  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5383  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5384  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5385  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5386  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5387  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5388  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5389  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5390  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5391  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5392  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5393  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5394  *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5395  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5396  *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5397  *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5398  *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5399  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5400  *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5401  *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5402  *	station.
5403  */
5404 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5405 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5406 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5407 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5408 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5409 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5410 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5411 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5412 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5413 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5414 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5415 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5416 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5417 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5418 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5419 
5420 	/* keep last */
5421 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5422 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5423 };
5424 
5425 /**
5426  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5427  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5428  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5429  *	a zero bit are ignored
5430  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5431  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5432  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5433  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5434  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5435  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5436  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5437  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5438  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5439  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5440  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5441  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5442  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5443  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5444  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5445  */
5446 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5447 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5448 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5449 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5450 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5451 
5452 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5453 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5454 };
5455 
5456 /**
5457  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5458  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5459  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5460  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5461  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5462  *
5463  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5464  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5465  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5466  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5467  * by the kernel to userspace.
5468  */
5469 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5470 	__u32 max_patterns;
5471 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5472 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5473 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5474 } __attribute__((packed));
5475 
5476 /* only for backward compatibility */
5477 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5478 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5479 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5480 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5481 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5482 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5483 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5484 
5485 /**
5486  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5487  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5488  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5489  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5490  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5491  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5492  *	any others are even supported by the device.
5493  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5494  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5495  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5496  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5497  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5498  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5499  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5500  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5501  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5502  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5503  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5504  *
5505  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5506  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5507  *
5508  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5509  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5510  *	to the kernel when configuring.
5511  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5512  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5513  *	by the device (flag)
5514  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5515  *	done by the device) (flag)
5516  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5517  *	packet (flag)
5518  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5519  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5520  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5521  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5522  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5523  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5524  *	attribute contains the original length.
5525  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5526  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5527  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5528  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5529  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5530  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5531  *	contains the original length.
5532  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5533  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5534  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5535  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5536  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5537  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5538  *	the TCP connection.
5539  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5540  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5541  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5542  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5543  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5544  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5545  *	service
5546  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5547  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5548  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5549  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5550  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5551  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5552  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5553  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5554  *	supported by the driver (u32).
5555  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5556  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5557  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5558  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5559  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5560  *	occurred.
5561  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5562  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5563  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5564  *	these attributes must be present.  If
5565  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5566  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5567  *	channel.
5568  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5569  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5570  *
5571  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5572  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5573  */
5574 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5575 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5576 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5577 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5578 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5579 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5580 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5581 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5582 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5583 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5584 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5585 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5586 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5587 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5588 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5589 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5590 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5591 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5592 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5593 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5594 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5595 
5596 	/* keep last */
5597 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5598 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5599 };
5600 
5601 /**
5602  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5603  *
5604  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5605  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5606  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5607  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5608  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5609  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5610  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5611  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5612  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5613  *
5614  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5615  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5616  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5617  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5618  * also woken up.
5619  *
5620  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5621  * response packets might not go through correctly.
5622  */
5623 
5624 /**
5625  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5626  * @start: starting value
5627  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5628  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5629  *
5630  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5631  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5632  * in little endian.
5633  */
5634 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5635 	__u32 start, offset, len;
5636 };
5637 
5638 /**
5639  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5640  * @offset: offset of token in packet
5641  * @len: length of each token
5642  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5643  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5644  */
5645 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5646 	__u32 offset, len;
5647 	__u8 token_stream[];
5648 };
5649 
5650 /**
5651  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5652  * @min_len: minimum token length
5653  * @max_len: maximum token length
5654  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5655  */
5656 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5657 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5658 };
5659 
5660 /**
5661  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5662  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5663  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5664  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5665  *	(in network byte order)
5666  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5667  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5668  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5669  *	might require ARP querying.
5670  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5671  *	socket and port will be allocated
5672  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5673  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5674  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5675  *	of the data payload.
5676  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5677  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5678  *	advertising it is just a flag
5679  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5680  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5681  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5682  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5683  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5684  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5685  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5686  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5687  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5688  *	but on the TCP payload only.
5689  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5690  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5691  */
5692 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5693 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5694 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5695 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5696 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5697 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5698 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5699 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5700 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5701 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5702 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5703 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5704 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5705 
5706 	/* keep last */
5707 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5708 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5709 };
5710 
5711 /**
5712  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5713  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5714  * @pat: packet pattern support information
5715  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5716  *
5717  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5718  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5719  */
5720 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5721 	__u32 max_rules;
5722 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5723 	__u32 max_delay;
5724 } __attribute__((packed));
5725 
5726 /**
5727  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5728  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5729  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5730  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5731  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5732  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5733  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5734  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5735  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5736  */
5737 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5738 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5739 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5740 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5741 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5742 
5743 	/* keep last */
5744 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5745 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5746 };
5747 
5748 /**
5749  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5750  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
5751  *	in a rule are matched.
5752  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5753  *	in a rule are not matched.
5754  */
5755 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5756 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5757 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5758 };
5759 
5760 /**
5761  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5762  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5763  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5764  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5765  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5766  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5767  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5768  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5769  */
5770 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5771 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5772 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5773 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5774 
5775 	/* keep last */
5776 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5777 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5778 };
5779 
5780 /**
5781  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
5782  *
5783  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5784  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
5785  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
5786  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
5787  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
5788  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
5789  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
5790  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
5791  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
5792  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
5793  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
5794  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
5795  *	different channels may be used within this group.
5796  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5797  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
5798  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5799  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
5800  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
5801  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
5802  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
5803  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
5804  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
5805  *
5806  * Examples:
5807  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
5808  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
5809  *
5810  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
5811  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
5812  *
5813  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
5814  *	=> allows two STAs on the same or on different channels
5815  *
5816  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
5817  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
5818  *
5819  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
5820  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
5821  * that any of these groups must match.
5822  *
5823  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
5824  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
5825  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
5826  * interface type, the following group always exists:
5827  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
5828  */
5829 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
5830 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
5831 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
5832 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
5833 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
5834 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
5835 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
5836 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
5837 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
5838 
5839 	/* keep last */
5840 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
5841 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
5842 };
5843 
5844 
5845 /**
5846  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
5847  *
5848  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
5849  *	state of non existent mesh peer links
5850  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
5851  *	this mesh peer
5852  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
5853  *	from this mesh peer
5854  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
5855  *	received from this mesh peer
5856  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
5857  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
5858  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
5859  *	plink are discarded, except for authentication frames
5860  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
5861  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
5862  */
5863 enum nl80211_plink_state {
5864 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
5865 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
5866 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
5867 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
5868 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
5869 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
5870 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
5871 
5872 	/* keep last */
5873 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
5874 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
5875 };
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
5879  *
5880  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
5881  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
5882  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
5883  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
5884  */
5885 enum plink_actions {
5886 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
5887 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
5888 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
5889 
5890 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
5891 };
5892 
5893 
5894 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
5895 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
5896 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
5897 #define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
5898 #define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN_32		32
5899 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
5900 
5901 /**
5902  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
5903  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5904  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
5905  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
5906  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
5907  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
5908  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
5909  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
5910  */
5911 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
5912 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
5913 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
5914 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
5915 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
5916 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
5917 
5918 	/* keep last */
5919 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
5920 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
5921 };
5922 
5923 /**
5924  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
5925  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
5926  *	Beacon frames)
5927  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
5928  *	in Beacon frames
5929  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
5930  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
5931  */
5932 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
5933 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
5934 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
5935 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
5936 };
5937 
5938 /**
5939  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
5940  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5941  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
5942  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
5943  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
5944  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
5945  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
5946  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
5947  */
5948 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
5949 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
5950 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
5951 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
5952 
5953 	/* keep last */
5954 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
5955 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
5956 };
5957 
5958 /**
5959  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
5960  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5961  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
5962  *	priority)
5963  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
5964  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
5965  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
5966  *	(internal)
5967  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
5968  *	(internal)
5969  */
5970 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
5971 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
5972 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
5973 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
5974 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
5975 
5976 	/* keep last */
5977 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
5978 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
5979 };
5980 
5981 /**
5982  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
5983  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
5984  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
5985  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
5986  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
5987  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
5988  */
5989 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
5990 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
5991 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
5992 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
5993 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
5994 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
5995 };
5996 
5997 /**
5998  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
5999  * @NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD: SA Query procedures offloaded to driver
6000  *	when user space indicates support for SA Query procedures offload during
6001  *	"start ap" with %NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT.
6002  */
6003 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
6004 	NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD		= 1 << 0,
6005 };
6006 
6007 /**
6008  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
6009  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
6010  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
6011  *	socket option.
6012  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
6013  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
6014  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
6015  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
6016  *	to work properly to support receiving regulatory hints from
6017  *	cellular base stations.
6018  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
6019  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
6020  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
6021  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
6022  *	mode
6023  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
6024  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
6025  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
6026  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
6027  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
6028  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
6029  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
6030  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
6031  *	setting
6032  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
6033  *	powersave
6034  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
6035  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
6036  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
6037  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
6038  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
6039  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
6040  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
6041  *	states using station flags.
6042  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
6043  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
6044  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
6045  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
6046  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
6047  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
6048  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
6049  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
6050  *	still generated by the driver.
6051  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
6052  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
6053  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
6054  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
6055  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
6056  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
6057  *	lifetime of a BSS.
6058  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
6059  *	Set IE to probe requests.
6060  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
6061  *	to probe requests.
6062  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
6063  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
6064  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
6065  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
6066  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
6067  *	Measurement Report action frame.
6068  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
6069  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
6070  *	to enable dynack.
6071  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
6072  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6073  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
6074  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
6075  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
6076  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
6077  *	rts/cts handshake.
6078  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
6079  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
6080  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
6081  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
6082  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
6083  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
6084  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
6085  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
6086  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
6087  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6088  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
6089  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
6090  *	address mask/value will be used.
6091  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
6092  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
6093  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6094  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6095  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
6096  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
6097  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
6098  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
6099  */
6100 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
6101 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
6102 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
6103 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
6104 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
6105 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
6106 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
6107 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
6108 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
6109 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
6110 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
6111 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
6112 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
6113 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
6114 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
6115 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
6116 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
6117 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
6118 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
6119 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
6120 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
6121 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
6122 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
6123 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
6124 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
6125 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
6126 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
6127 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
6128 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
6129 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
6130 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
6131 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
6132 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
6133 };
6134 
6135 /**
6136  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
6137  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
6138  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
6139  *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
6140  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
6141  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
6142  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
6143  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
6144  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
6145  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
6146  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
6147  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
6148  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
6149  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
6150  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
6151  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6152  *	(if available).
6153  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
6154  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
6155  *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
6156  *	(if available).
6157  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
6158  *	channel dwell time.
6159  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
6160  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
6161  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
6162  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
6163  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
6164  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
6165  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
6166  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
6167  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
6168  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
6169  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
6170  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
6171  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
6172  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
6173  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
6174  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
6175  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
6176  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
6177  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
6178  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
6179  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6180  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
6181  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
6182  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
6183  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
6184  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
6185  *	be supported.
6186  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
6187  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
6188  *	actual dwell time.
6189  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
6190  *	response
6191  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
6192  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
6193  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
6194  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
6195  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
6196  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
6197  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
6198  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
6199  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
6200  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
6201  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
6202  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
6203  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
6204  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
6205  *	"radar detected" event.
6206  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
6207  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
6208  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
6209  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
6210  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
6211  *      TXQs.
6212  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
6213  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
6214  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
6215  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
6216  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
6217  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
6218  *	timing measurement responder role.
6219  *
6220  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
6221  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
6222  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
6223  *      freeze the connection.
6224  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
6225  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
6226  *
6227  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
6228  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
6229  *	scheduling.
6230  *
6231  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
6232  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
6233  *
6234  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports
6235  *	filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds.
6236  *
6237  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
6238  *	to a station.
6239  *
6240  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
6241  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
6242  *
6243  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
6244  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
6245  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
6246  *
6247  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
6248  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
6249  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
6250  *
6251  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
6252  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
6253  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
6254  *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
6255  *
6256  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
6257  *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
6258  *	handled as ordinary data frames.
6259  *
6260  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
6261  *
6262  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
6263  *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
6264  *
6265  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
6266  *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
6267  *
6268  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
6269  *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
6270  *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
6271  *	included in the scan request.
6272  *
6273  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
6274  *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
6275  *
6276  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
6277  *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
6278  *
6279  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
6280  *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
6281  *	command).
6282  *
6283  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
6284  *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
6285  *
6286  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
6287  *	frames transmission
6288  *
6289  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
6290  *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
6291  *
6292  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
6293  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
6294  *
6295  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
6296  *      exchange protocol.
6297  *
6298  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
6299  *      exchange protocol.
6300  *
6301  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
6302  *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
6303  *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
6304  *
6305  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR: The driver supports BSS color collision
6306  *	detection and change announcemnts.
6307  *
6308  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD: Driver running in AP mode supports
6309  *	FILS encryption and decryption for (Re)Association Request and Response
6310  *	frames. Userspace has to share FILS AAD details to the driver by using
6311  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_FILS_AAD.
6312  *
6313  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND: Device supports background radar/CAC
6314  *	detection.
6315  *
6316  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE: Device can perform a MAC address
6317  *	change without having to bring the underlying network device down
6318  *	first. For example, in station mode this can be used to vary the
6319  *	origin MAC address prior to a connection to a new AP for privacy
6320  *	or other reasons. Note that certain driver specific restrictions
6321  *	might apply, e.g. no scans in progress, no offchannel operations
6322  *	in progress, and no active connections.
6323  *
6324  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT: Driver supports preamble puncturing in AP mode.
6325  *
6326  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN: Device supports NAN Pairing which enables
6327  *	authentication, data encryption and message integrity.
6328  *
6329  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
6330  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
6331  */
6332 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
6333 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
6334 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
6335 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
6336 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
6337 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
6338 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
6339 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
6340 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
6341 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
6342 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
6343 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
6344 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
6345 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
6346 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
6347 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
6348 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
6349 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
6350 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
6351 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6352 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
6353 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
6354 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
6355 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
6356 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
6357 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
6358 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
6359 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
6360 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6361 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
6362 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
6363 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
6364 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
6365 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
6366 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
6367 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
6368 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
6369 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
6370 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD,
6371 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
6372 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
6373 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
6374 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
6375 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6376 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6377 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6378 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6379 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6380 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6381 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6382 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6383 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6384 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6385 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6386 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6387 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6388 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6389 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6390 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6391 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6392 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6393 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_COLOR,
6394 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_CRYPTO_OFFLOAD,
6395 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RADAR_BACKGROUND,
6396 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_POWERED_ADDR_CHANGE,
6397 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PUNCT,
6398 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_NAN,
6399 
6400 	/* add new features before the definition below */
6401 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6402 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6403 };
6404 
6405 /**
6406  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6407  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6408  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6409  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6410  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6411  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6412  *	to the host.
6413  *
6414  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6415  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6416  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6417  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6418  */
6419 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6420 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6421 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6422 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6423 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6424 };
6425 
6426 /**
6427  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6428  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6429  *	handled by the AP is reached.
6430  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6431  */
6432 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6433 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6434 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6435 };
6436 
6437 /**
6438  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6439  *
6440  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6441  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6442  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6443  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6444  */
6445 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6446 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6447 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6448 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6449 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6450 };
6451 
6452 /**
6453  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6454  *
6455  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6456  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6457  * requests.
6458  *
6459  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6460  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6461  * one of them can be used in the request.
6462  *
6463  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6464  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6465  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6466  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6467  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6468  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6469  *	when really needed
6470  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6471  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6472  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6473  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6474  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6475  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6476  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6477  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6478  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6479  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6480  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6481  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6482  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6483  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6484  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6485  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6486  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6487  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6488  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6489  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6490  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6491  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6492  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6493  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6494  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6495  *	impacted with this flag.
6496  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6497  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6498  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6499  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6500  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6501  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6502  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6503  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6504  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6505  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6506  *	possible.
6507  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6508  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6509  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6510  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6511  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6512  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6513  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for colocated APs reported by
6514  *	2.4/5 GHz APs
6515  */
6516 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6517 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6518 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6519 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6520 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6521 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6522 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6523 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6524 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6525 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6526 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6527 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6528 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6529 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6530 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6531 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6532 };
6533 
6534 /**
6535  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6536  *
6537  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6538  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6539  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6540  *
6541  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6542  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6543  *	in ACL to authenticate.
6544  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6545  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6546  */
6547 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6548 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6549 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6550 };
6551 
6552 /**
6553  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6554  *
6555  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6556  *
6557  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6558  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6559  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6560  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6561  */
6562 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6563 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6564 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6565 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6566 
6567 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6568 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6569 };
6570 
6571 /**
6572  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6573  *
6574  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6575  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6576  *
6577  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6578  *	now unusable.
6579  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6580  *	the channel is now available.
6581  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6582  *	change to the channel status.
6583  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6584  *	over, channel becomes usable.
6585  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6586  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6587  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6588  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6589  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6590  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6591  */
6592 enum nl80211_radar_event {
6593 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6594 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6595 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6596 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6597 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6598 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6599 };
6600 
6601 /**
6602  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6603  *
6604  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6605  *
6606  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6607  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6608  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6609  *	is therefore marked as not available.
6610  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6611  */
6612 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6613 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6614 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6615 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6616 };
6617 
6618 /**
6619  * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6620  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6621  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6622  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6623  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6624  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6625  */
6626 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6627 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6628 };
6629 
6630 /**
6631  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6632  *
6633  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6634  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6635  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6636  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6637  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6638  */
6639 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6640 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6641 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6642 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6643 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6644 	/* add other protocols before this one */
6645 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6646 };
6647 
6648 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6649 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6650 
6651 /**
6652  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6653  *
6654  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6655  *
6656  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6657  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6658  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6659  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6660  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6661  */
6662 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6663 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6664 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6665 };
6666 
6667 /*
6668  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6669  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6670  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6671  */
6672 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6673 
6674 /**
6675  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6676  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6677  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6678  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6679  *	added to this file when needed.
6680  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6681  */
6682 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6683 	__u32 vendor_id;
6684 	__u32 subcmd;
6685 };
6686 
6687 /**
6688  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6689  *
6690  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6691  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6692  *
6693  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6694  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6695  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6696  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
6697  */
6698 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6699 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6700 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6701 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6702 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
6703 };
6704 
6705 /**
6706  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6707  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6708  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6709  *	seconds (u32).
6710  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
6711  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
6712  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
6713  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
6714  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6715  *	currently defined
6716  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6717  */
6718 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6719 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6720 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6721 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6722 
6723 	/* keep last */
6724 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6725 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6726 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6727 };
6728 
6729 /**
6730  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6731  *
6732  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6733  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6734  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6735  */
6736 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6737 	__u8 band;
6738 	__s8 delta;
6739 } __attribute__((packed));
6740 
6741 /**
6742  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6743  *
6744  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
6745  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
6746  *	is requested.
6747  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
6748  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
6749  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
6750  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
6751  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
6752  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
6753  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
6754  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
6755  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
6756  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
6757  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
6758  *
6759  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
6760  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
6761  * which the driver shall use.
6762  */
6763 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
6764 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
6765 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
6766 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
6767 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
6768 
6769 	/* keep last */
6770 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
6771 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
6772 };
6773 
6774 /**
6775  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
6776  *
6777  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
6778  *
6779  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
6780  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
6781  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
6782  */
6783 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
6784 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
6785 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
6786 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
6787 
6788 	/* keep last */
6789 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
6790 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
6791 };
6792 
6793 /**
6794  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
6795  *
6796  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
6797  *
6798  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
6799  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
6800  */
6801 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
6802 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
6803 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
6804 };
6805 
6806 /**
6807  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
6808  *
6809  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
6810  *
6811  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
6812  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
6813  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
6814  */
6815 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
6816 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
6817 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
6818 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
6819 };
6820 
6821 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
6822 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
6823 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
6824 
6825 /**
6826  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
6827  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
6828  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
6829  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
6830  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
6831  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
6832  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
6833  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
6834  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
6835  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
6836  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
6837  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
6838  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
6839  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
6840  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
6841  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
6842  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
6843  *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
6844  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
6845  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
6846  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
6847  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
6848  *	This is a flag.
6849  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
6850  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
6851  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
6852  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
6853  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
6854  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
6855  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
6856  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6857  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
6858  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6859  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
6860  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
6861  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
6862  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
6863  *
6864  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
6865  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
6866  */
6867 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
6868 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
6869 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
6870 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
6871 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
6872 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
6873 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
6874 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
6875 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
6876 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
6877 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
6878 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
6879 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
6880 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
6881 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
6882 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
6883 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
6884 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
6885 
6886 	/* keep last */
6887 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
6888 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
6889 };
6890 
6891 /**
6892  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
6893  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
6894  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
6895  *	This is a flag.
6896  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
6897  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
6898  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
6899  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
6900  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
6901  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
6902  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
6903  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
6904  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
6905  */
6906 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
6907 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
6908 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
6909 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
6910 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
6911 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
6912 
6913 	/* keep last */
6914 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
6915 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
6916 };
6917 
6918 /**
6919  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
6920  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
6921  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
6922  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
6923  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6924  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
6925  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
6926  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6927  *
6928  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
6929  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
6930  */
6931 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
6932 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
6933 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
6934 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
6935 
6936 	/* keep last */
6937 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
6938 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
6939 };
6940 
6941 /**
6942  * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
6943  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
6944  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
6945  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
6946  */
6947 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
6948 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
6949 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
6950 };
6951 
6952 /**
6953  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
6954  *	responder attributes
6955  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6956  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
6957  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
6958  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
6959  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6960  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
6961  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
6962  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6963  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
6964  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
6965  */
6966 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
6967 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6968 
6969 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
6970 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
6971 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
6972 
6973 	/* keep last */
6974 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
6975 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
6976 };
6977 
6978 /*
6979  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
6980  *
6981  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
6982  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
6983  *
6984  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6985  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
6986  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
6987  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
6988  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
6989  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
6990  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
6991  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
6992  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
6993  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
6994  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
6995  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
6996  *	phase with the responder (u32)
6997  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
6998  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
6999  *	FTM slot (u32)
7000  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
7001  *	scheduled window (u32)
7002  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
7003  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
7004  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
7005  */
7006 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
7007 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
7008 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
7009 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
7010 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
7011 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
7012 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
7013 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
7014 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7015 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
7016 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
7017 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
7018 
7019 	/* keep last */
7020 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
7021 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
7022 };
7023 
7024 /**
7025  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
7026  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
7027  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
7028  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
7029  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
7030  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
7031  */
7032 enum nl80211_preamble {
7033 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
7034 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
7035 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
7036 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
7037 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
7038 };
7039 
7040 /**
7041  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
7042  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
7043  *	these numbers also for attributes
7044  *
7045  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
7046  *
7047  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
7048  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
7049  */
7050 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
7051 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
7052 
7053 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
7054 
7055 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
7056 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
7057 };
7058 
7059 /**
7060  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
7061  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
7062  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
7063  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
7064  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
7065  *	reason may be available in the response data
7066  */
7067 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
7068 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
7069 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
7070 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
7071 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
7072 };
7073 
7074 /**
7075  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
7076  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7077  *
7078  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7079  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
7080  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
7081  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
7082  *	(flag attribute)
7083  *
7084  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
7085  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7086  */
7087 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
7088 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7089 
7090 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
7091 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
7092 
7093 	/* keep last */
7094 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
7095 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
7096 };
7097 
7098 /**
7099  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
7100  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7101  *
7102  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
7103  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
7104  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
7105  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
7106  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
7107  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
7108  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
7109  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
7110  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
7111  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
7112  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
7113  *	(u64, usec)
7114  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
7115  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
7116  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
7117  *	result.
7118  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
7119  *
7120  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
7121  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7122  */
7123 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
7124 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7125 
7126 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
7127 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
7128 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
7129 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
7130 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
7131 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7132 
7133 	/* keep last */
7134 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
7135 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
7136 };
7137 
7138 /**
7139  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
7140  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7141  *
7142  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
7143  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
7144  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
7145  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7146  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7147  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
7148  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
7149  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
7150  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
7151  *
7152  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
7153  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7154  */
7155 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
7156 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
7157 
7158 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
7159 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
7160 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
7161 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
7162 
7163 	/* keep last */
7164 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
7165 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
7166 };
7167 
7168 /**
7169  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
7170  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7171  *
7172  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
7173  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
7174  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
7175  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
7176  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
7177  *	measurement results
7178  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
7179  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
7180  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
7181  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
7182  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
7183  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
7184  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
7185  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
7186  *	sub-attributes taken from
7187  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
7188  *
7189  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
7190  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7191  */
7192 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
7193 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
7194 
7195 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
7196 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
7197 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
7198 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
7199 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
7200 
7201 	/* keep last */
7202 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
7203 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
7204 };
7205 
7206 /**
7207  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
7208  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7209  *
7210  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
7211  *	is supported
7212  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
7213  *	mode is supported
7214  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
7215  *	data can be requested during the measurement
7216  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
7217  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
7218  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
7219  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
7220  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
7221  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
7222  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
7223  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
7224  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
7225  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
7226  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
7227  *	is valid)
7228  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
7229  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
7230  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
7231  *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7232  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
7233  *	if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
7234  *
7235  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
7236  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7237  */
7238 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
7239 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
7240 
7241 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
7242 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
7243 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
7244 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
7245 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
7246 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
7247 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
7248 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7249 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7250 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7251 
7252 	/* keep last */
7253 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
7254 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
7255 };
7256 
7257 /**
7258  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
7259  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7260  *
7261  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
7262  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
7263  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
7264  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
7265  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
7266  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7267  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
7268  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
7269  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
7270  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
7271  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
7272  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
7273  *	requested per burst
7274  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
7275  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
7276  *	(u8, default 3)
7277  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
7278  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
7279  *	(flag)
7280  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
7281  *	measurement (flag).
7282  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
7283  *	mutually exclusive.
7284  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7285  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7286  *	ranging will be used.
7287  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based
7288  *	ranging measurement (flag)
7289  *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
7290  *	mutually exclusive.
7291  *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
7292  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
7293  *	ranging will be used.
7294  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
7295  *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
7296  *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7297  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR: optional. The BSS color of the
7298  *	responder. Only valid if %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED
7299  *	or %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
7300  *
7301  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
7302  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7303  */
7304 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
7305 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
7306 
7307 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
7308 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
7309 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7310 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
7311 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7312 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7313 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
7314 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
7315 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
7316 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
7317 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
7318 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
7319 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BSS_COLOR,
7320 
7321 	/* keep last */
7322 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
7323 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
7324 };
7325 
7326 /**
7327  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
7328  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
7329  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
7330  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
7331  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
7332  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
7333  *	try and get no response)
7334  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
7335  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
7336  *	received
7337  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
7338  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
7339  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
7340  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
7341  */
7342 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
7343 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
7344 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
7345 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
7346 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
7347 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
7348 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
7349 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
7350 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
7351 };
7352 
7353 /**
7354  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
7355  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
7356  *
7357  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
7358  *	(u32, optional)
7359  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
7360  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
7361  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
7362  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
7363  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
7364  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
7365  *	that were acknowleged (u32, optional)
7366  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
7367  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
7368  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
7369  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7370  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
7371  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
7372  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
7373  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
7374  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
7375  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7376  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
7377  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
7378  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
7379  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
7380  *	attributes)
7381  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
7382  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
7383  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
7384  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7385  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7386  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7387  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7388  *	optional)
7389  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7390  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7391  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7392  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7393  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7394  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7395  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7396  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7397  *	Type 8.
7398  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7399  *	(binary, optional);
7400  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7401  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7402  *	Type 11.
7403  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7404  *
7405  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7406  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7407  */
7408 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7409 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7410 
7411 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7412 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7413 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7414 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7415 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7416 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7417 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7418 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7419 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7420 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7421 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7422 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7423 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7424 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7425 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7426 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7427 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7428 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7429 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7430 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7431 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7432 
7433 	/* keep last */
7434 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7435 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7436 };
7437 
7438 /**
7439  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7440  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7441  *
7442  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7443  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7444  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7445  *	tx power offset.
7446  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7447  *	values used by members of the SRG.
7448  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7449  *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7450  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7451  *
7452  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7453  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7454  */
7455 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7456 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7457 
7458 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7459 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7460 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7461 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7462 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7463 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7464 
7465 	/* keep last */
7466 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7467 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7468 };
7469 
7470 /**
7471  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7472  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7473  *
7474  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7475  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7476  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7477  *
7478  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7479  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7480  */
7481 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7482 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7483 
7484 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7485 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7486 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7487 
7488 	/* keep last */
7489 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7490 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7491 };
7492 
7493 /**
7494  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7495  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7496  *
7497  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7498  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7499  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7500  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7501  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7502  *
7503  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7504  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7505  */
7506 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7507 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7508 
7509 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7510 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7511 
7512 	/* keep last */
7513 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7514 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7515 };
7516 
7517 /**
7518  * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7519  * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7520  *
7521  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7522  *
7523  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7524  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7525  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7526  *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7527  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7528  *	frame including the headers.
7529  *
7530  * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7531  * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7532  */
7533 enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7534 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7535 
7536 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7537 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7538 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7539 
7540 	/* keep last */
7541 	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7542 	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7543 };
7544 
7545 /*
7546  * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7547  * mandatory fields.
7548  */
7549 #define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7550 
7551 /**
7552  * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7553  *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7554  *
7555  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7556  *
7557  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7558  *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7559  *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning).
7560  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7561  *	frame template (binary).
7562  *
7563  * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7564  * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7565  */
7566 enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7567 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7568 
7569 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7570 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7571 
7572 	/* keep last */
7573 	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7574 	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7575 		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7576 };
7577 
7578 /**
7579  * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7580  *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7581  *	used.
7582  *
7583  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7584  *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7585  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7586  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7587  * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7588  *	can be used.
7589  */
7590 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7591 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7592 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7593 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7594 	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7595 };
7596 
7597 /**
7598  * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7599  *
7600  * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7601  *
7602  */
7603 enum nl80211_sar_type {
7604 	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7605 
7606 	/* add new type here */
7607 
7608 	/* Keep last */
7609 	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7610 };
7611 
7612 /**
7613  * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7614  *
7615  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7616  *
7617  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7618  *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7619  *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7620  *
7621  *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7622  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7623  *
7624  *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7625  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7626  *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7627  *
7628  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7629  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7630  *
7631  * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7632  */
7633 enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7634 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7635 
7636 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7637 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7638 
7639 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7640 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7641 };
7642 
7643 /**
7644  * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7645  *
7646  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7647  *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7648  *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7649  *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7650  *
7651  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7652  *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7653  *	is applied to this range.
7654  *
7655  *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7656  *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7657  *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7658  *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7659  *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7660  *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7661  *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7662  *
7663  *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7664  *
7665  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7666  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7667  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7668  *
7669  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7670  *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7671  *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7672  *
7673  * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7674  * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7675  */
7676 enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7677 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7678 
7679 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7680 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7681 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7682 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7683 
7684 	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7685 	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7686 };
7687 
7688 /**
7689  * enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes - multiple BSSID (MBSSID) and enhanced
7690  * multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA) in AP mode.
7691  * Kernel uses some of these attributes to advertise driver's support for
7692  * MBSSID and EMA.
7693  * Remaining attributes should be used by the userspace to configure the
7694  * features.
7695  *
7696  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7697  *
7698  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES: Used by the kernel to advertise
7699  *	the maximum number of MBSSID interfaces supported by the driver.
7700  *	Driver should indicate MBSSID support by setting
7701  *	wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces to a value more than or equal to 2.
7702  *
7703  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY: Used by the kernel
7704  *	to advertise the maximum profile periodicity supported by the driver
7705  *	if EMA is enabled. Driver should indicate EMA support to the userspace
7706  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to
7707  *	a non-zero value.
7708  *
7709  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX: Mandatory parameter to pass the index of
7710  *	this BSS (u8) in the multiple BSSID set.
7711  *	Value must be set to 0 for the transmitting interface and non-zero for
7712  *	all non-transmitting interfaces. The userspace will be responsible
7713  *	for using unique indices for the interfaces.
7714  *	Range: 0 to wiphy->mbssid_max_interfaces-1.
7715  *
7716  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX: Mandatory parameter for
7717  *	a non-transmitted profile which provides the interface index (u32) of
7718  *	the transmitted profile. The value must match one of the interface
7719  *	indices advertised by the kernel. Optional if the interface being set up
7720  *	is the transmitting one, however, if provided then the value must match
7721  *	the interface index of the same.
7722  *
7723  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA: Flag used to enable EMA AP feature.
7724  *	Setting this flag is permitted only if the driver advertises EMA support
7725  *	by setting wiphy->ema_max_profile_periodicity to non-zero.
7726  *
7727  * @__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7728  * @NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7729  */
7730 enum nl80211_mbssid_config_attributes {
7731 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
7732 
7733 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_INTERFACES,
7734 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX_EMA_PROFILE_PERIODICITY,
7735 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_INDEX,
7736 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_IFINDEX,
7737 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_EMA,
7738 
7739 	/* keep last */
7740 	__NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST,
7741 	NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MBSSID_CONFIG_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7742 };
7743 
7744 /**
7745  * enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
7746  *
7747  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external
7748  *	authentication.
7749  * @NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT: Userspace supports SA Query
7750  *	procedures offload to driver. If driver advertises
7751  *	%NL80211_AP_SME_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD in AP SME features, userspace shall
7752  *	ignore SA Query procedures and validations when this flag is set by
7753  *	userspace.
7754  */
7755 enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags {
7756 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= 1 << 0,
7757 	NL80211_AP_SETTINGS_SA_QUERY_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT	= 1 << 1,
7758 };
7759 
7760 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
7761